WO2014106199A1 - Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols - Google Patents
Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- WO2014106199A1 WO2014106199A1 PCT/US2013/078343 US2013078343W WO2014106199A1 WO 2014106199 A1 WO2014106199 A1 WO 2014106199A1 US 2013078343 W US2013078343 W US 2013078343W WO 2014106199 A1 WO2014106199 A1 WO 2014106199A1
- Authority
- WO
- WIPO (PCT)
- Prior art keywords
- event
- transistor
- structure configured
- data
- signaling
- Prior art date
Links
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W4/00—Services specially adapted for wireless communication networks; Facilities therefor
- H04W4/02—Services making use of location information
- H04W4/021—Services related to particular areas, e.g. point of interest [POI] services, venue services or geofences
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L63/00—Network architectures or network communication protocols for network security
- H04L63/02—Network architectures or network communication protocols for network security for separating internal from external traffic, e.g. firewalls
- H04L63/0227—Filtering policies
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W12/00—Security arrangements; Authentication; Protecting privacy or anonymity
- H04W12/08—Access security
- H04W12/088—Access security using filters or firewalls
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W4/00—Services specially adapted for wireless communication networks; Facilities therefor
- H04W4/02—Services making use of location information
- H04W4/029—Location-based management or tracking services
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W8/00—Network data management
- H04W8/005—Discovery of network devices, e.g. terminals
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W4/00—Services specially adapted for wireless communication networks; Facilities therefor
- H04W4/02—Services making use of location information
- H04W4/023—Services making use of location information using mutual or relative location information between multiple location based services [LBS] targets or of distance thresholds
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W76/00—Connection management
- H04W76/10—Connection setup
- H04W76/14—Direct-mode setup
Definitions
- This disclosure relates to facilitating connectivity in wireless communications.
- An embodiment provides a method.
- the method includes but is not limited to establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data bloclv delivery failure rate of the wirel ess communication channel via. the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold.
- related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. ⁇ 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0005]
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the
- An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product.
- the article of manufacture includes but is not, limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block del i very failure rate of the wirel ess communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold.
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions.
- the instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold.
- An embodiment provides a method.
- the method includes but is not limited to obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second
- related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.8.C. ⁇ 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer.
- An embodiment provides a system .
- the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and circuitry for causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
- An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product.
- the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
- a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
- the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions.
- the instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
- An embodiment provides a method.
- the method includes but is not limited to obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first, device being within a wireless comm unication range of a second device. (In such contexts, an interval is "recent" if it began yesterday or today.)
- other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
- related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. ⁇ 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0015]
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and circuitry for signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device.
- circuitry for obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour circuitry for signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device
- An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product.
- the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device.
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions.
- the instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first dev ice being within a wireless communication range of a second device.
- An embodiment provides a method.
- the method includes but is not limited to obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
- related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. ⁇ 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0020]
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; circuitry for obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not, to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
- An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product.
- the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal -bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions.
- the instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol: obtaining via. a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and signaling a decision whether or not, to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access sendee and the second network access service.
- An embodiment provides a method.
- the method includes but is not limited to obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a later time.
- related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. ⁇ 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer.
- an embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a. later time.
- An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product.
- the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first sendee region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from, a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not, at a later time.
- a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first sendee region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from, a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not, at a later time.
- An embodiment provides a system.
- the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions.
- the instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a later time.
- FIG. 1 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented on a city street.
- FIG. 2 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented between a primary device and a. secondary device.
- FIG. 3 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented among electrical nodes and transistors of an integrated circuit.
- FIG. 4 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a handheld device
- FIG. S depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in an application-specific integrated circuit (ASIC).
- ASIC application-specific integrated circuit
- FIG, 6 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in control logic.
- FIGS. 7-13 each depict, another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
- FIG. 14 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a user interface.
- FIG. 15 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a stationary device, a vehicle, or a handheld device.
- FIG. 16 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a supervisor unit.
- FIG, 17 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a communications network.
- FIG, 18 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
- FIG, 19 depicts another exemplary environment, in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a device that facilitates interpersonal
- FIGS. 20-23 each depict, an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in one or more data-handling media.
- FIG, 24 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
- FIG, 25 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
- FIG. 26 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a detection unit.
- FIG. 27 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- FIG. 32 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 27, e.g.).
- FIG. 28 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- FIG. 33 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 28, e.g.).
- FIG. 29 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- FIG. 34 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 29, e.g.).
- FIG. 30 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- FIG. 35 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 30, e.g.),
- FIG, 31 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be impleme ted.
- FIG, 36 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 31, e.g.).
- FIG. 37 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
- FIG, 38 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
- FIG. 39 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
- FIG. 40 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
- FIG. 41 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
- the implementer may opt for a mainly hardware and/or firmware vehicle; alternatively, if flexibility is paramount, the implementer may opt for a. mainly software implementation; or, yet again alternatively, the implementer may opt for some combination of hardware, software, and/or firmware in one or more machines, compositions of matter, and articles of manufacture, limited to patentable subject matter under 35 USC 101.
- the processes and/or devices and/or other technologies described herein may be effected, none of which is inherently superior to the other in that any vehicle to be utilized is a.
- logic and similar implementations may include software or other control structures.
- Electronic circuitry for example, may- have one or more paths of electrical current constructed and arranged to implement various functions as described herein .
- one or more media may be configured to bear a device-detectable implementation when such media hold or transmit device detectable instructions operable to perform as described herein.
- implementations may include an update or modification of existing software or firmware, or of gate arrays or programmable hardware, such as by performing a reception of or a transmission of one or more instructions in relation to one or more operations described herein.
- an implementation may include special-purpose hardware, software, firmware components, and/or general-purpose components executing or otherwise invoicing special-purpose components. Specifications or other implementations may be transmitted by one or more instances of tangible transmission media as described herein, optionally by packet transmission or otherwise by passing through distributed media at various times.
- implementations may include executing a special- purpose instruction sequence or invoking circuitry for enabling, triggering, coordinating, requesting, or otherwise causing one or more occurrences of virtually any functional operations described herein.
- operational or other logical descriptions herein may be expressed as source code and compiled or otherwise invoked as an executable instruction sequence.
- implementations may be provided, in whole or in part, by source code, such as C++, or other code sequences.
- source or other code implementation using commercially available and/or techniques in the art, may be compiled/
- a high-level descriptor language e.g., initially implementing described technologies in C or C++ programming language and thereafter converting the programming language implementation into a logic-synthesizable language implementation, a hardware description language implementation, a hardware design simulation implementation, and/or other such similar mode(s) of expression).
- a logical expression e.g., computer programming language implementation
- a Verilog-type hardware description e.g., via Hardware Description Language (HDL) and/or Very High Speed Integrated Circuit Hardware Descriptor Language (VHDL)
- VHDL Very High Speed Integrated Circuit Hardware Descriptor Language
- Those skilled in the art will recognize how to obtain, configure, and optimize suitable transmission or computational elements, material supplies, actuators, or other structures in light of these teachings.
- the logical operations/functions described herein are a distillation of machine specifications or other physical mechanisms specified by the operations/functions such that the otherwise inscrutable machine specifications may be comprehensible to a human reader.
- the distillation also allows one of skill in the art to adapt the
- VHDL Very high speed Hardware Description Language
- software e.g., C, Java, visual basic
- tools in the form of Very high speed Hardware Description Language are generators of static or sequenced specifications of various hardware configurations. This fact is sometimes obscured by the broad term “software,” but, as shown by the following explanation, those skilled in the art understand that what is termed “software” is a shorthand for a massively complex interchaining/specification of ordered-matter elements.
- ordered-matter elements may refer to physical components of computation, such as assemblies of electronic logic gates, molecular computing logic constituents, quantum computing mechanisms, etc.
- a high-level programming language is a programming language with strong abstraction, e.g., multiple levels of abstraction, from the details of the sequential organizations, states, inputs, outputs, etc., of the machines that a high-level programming language actually specifies.
- strong abstraction e.g., multiple levels of abstraction, from the details of the sequential organizations, states, inputs, outputs, etc., of the machines that a high-level programming language actually specifies.
- the hardware used in the computational machines typically consists of some type of ordered matter ⁇ e.g., traditional electronic devices (e.g., transistors), deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA), quantum devices, mechanical switches, optics, fluidics, pneumatics, optical devices ⁇ e.g., optical interference devices), molecules, etc.) that are arranged to form logic gates.
- Logic gates are typically physical devices that may be electrically, mechanically, chemically, or otherwise driven to change physical state in order to create a physical reality of logic, such as Boolean logic.
- Logic gates may be arranged to form logic circuits, which are typically physical devices that may be electrically, mechanically, chemically, or otherwise driven to create a physical reality of certain logical functions.
- Types of logic circuits include such devices as multiplexers, registers, arithmetic logic units (ALUs), computer memory, etc., each type of which may he combined to form yet other types of physical devices, such as a central processing unit (CPU)— the best known of which is the microprocessor.
- CPU central processing unit
- a modern microprocessor will often contain more than one hundred million logic gates in its many logic circuits (and often more than a billion transistors). See, e.g., Wikipedia, Logic gates, http://en.wikipedia.org/vviki/Logic__gates (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :03 GMT).
- the logic circuits forming the microprocessor are arranged to provide a microarchitecture that, will carry out the instructions defined by that microprocessor's defined Instruction Set Architecture.
- the Instruction Set Architecture is the part of the microprocessor architecture related to programming, including the native data types, instructions, registers, addressing modes, memory architecture, interrupt and exception handling, and externa] input/Output, See, e.g., Wikipedia, Computer architecture, http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Computer__architecture (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :03 G MT).
- the Instruction Set Architecture includes a specification of the machine language that can be used by programmers to use/control the microprocessor. Since the machine language instructions are such that they may be executed directly by the microprocessor, typically they consist of strings of binary digits, or bits. For example, a typical machine language instruction might be many bits long (e.g., 32, 64, or 128 bit strings are currently common). A typical machine language instruction might take the form " 1 1 1 1000010101 1 1 100001 1 1 1001 1 1 1 1” (a 32 bit instruction).
- the binary number "1 " (e.g., logical "1 ") in a machine language instruction specifies around +5 volts applied to a specific "wire” (e.g., metallic traces on a printed circuit board) and the binary number "0" (e.g., logical "0") in a machine language instruction specifies around -5 volts applied to a specific "wire.”
- a specific "wire e.g., metallic traces on a printed circuit board
- the binary number "0" e.g., logical "0”
- machine language instructions also select out and activate specific groupings of logic gates from the millions of logic gates of the more general machine.
- machine language instruction programs even though written as a string of zeros and ones, specify many, many constructed physical machines or physical machine states.
- Machine language is typically incomprehensible by most humans (e.g., the above example was just ONE instruction, and some personal computers execute more than two billion instructions every second). See, e.g., Wikipedia, Instructions per second, ht ⁇ ://en.wikipedia.org/wild/Instmctions_per_second (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :04 GMT).
- a compiler is a device that takes a statement that is more comprehensible to a human than either machine or assembly language, such as "add 2 + 2 and output the result," and translates that human understandable statement into a complicated, tedious, and immense machine language code (e.g., millions of 32, 64, or 128 bit length strings). Compilers thus translate high-level programming language into machine language.
- This compiled machine language is then used as the technical specification which sequentially constructs and causes the interoperation of many different computational machines such that useful, tangible, and concrete work is done. For example, as indicated above, such machine language- the compiled version of the higher-level language- functions as a technical specification which selects out hardware logic gates, specifies voltage levels, voltage transition timings, etc., such that the useful work is accomplished by the hardware.
- the logical operations/functions set forth in the present technical description are representative of static or sequenced specifications of various ordered-matter elements, in order that such specifications may be comprehensible to the human mind and adaptable to create many various hardware configurations.
- the logical operations/functions disclosed herein should be treated as such, and should not be disparagingly characterized as abstract ideas merely because the specifications they represent are presented in a manner that one of skill in the art can readily understand and apply in a manner independent of a specific vendor's hardware implementation.
- examples of such other devices and/or processes and/or systems might include - as appropriate to context and application— all or part of devices and/or processes and/or systems of (a) an air conveyance (e.g., an airplane, rocket, helicopter, etc.) , (b) a ground conveyance (e.g., a car, truck, locomotive, tank, armored personnel carrier, etc.), (c) a building (e.g., a home, warehouse, office, etc.), (d) an appliance (e.g., a refrigerator, a washing machine, a dryer, etc.), (e) a communications system (e.g., a networked system, a telephone system, a Voice over IP system, etc.), (f) a business entity e.g., an Internet Service Provider (ISP) entity such as Comcast Cable, Qwest, Southwestern Bell, etc.), or (g) a wired/wireless services entity (e.g., Sprint, Cingular
- use of a system or method may occur in a territory even if components are located outside the territory.
- use of a distributed computing system may occur in a territory even though parts of the system may be located outside of the territory (e.g., relay, server, processor, signal- bearing medium, transmitting computer, receiving computer, etc. located outside the territory).
- a sale of a system or method may likewise occur in a territory even if components of the system or method are located and/or used outside the territory.
- implementation of at least part of a system for performing a method in one territory does not preclude use of the system in another territory
- any two components so associated can also be viewed as being “operably connected”, or “operably coupled,” to each other to achieve the desired functionality, and any two components capable of being so associated can also be viewed as being “operably couplable,” to each other to achieve the desired functionality.
- operably couplable include but are not limited to physically mateable and/or physically interacting components, and/or wirelessly interactable, aml/or wirelessly interacting components, and'Or logically interacting, and/or logically interactable components.
- one or more components may be referred to herein as “configured to,” “configured by,” “configurable to,” “operable/operative to,”
- electro-mechanical system includes, but is not, limited to, electrical circuitry operably coupled with a transducer (e.g., an actuator, a motor, a piezoelectric crystal, a Micro Electro Mechanical System (MEMS), etc.), electrical circuitry having at least one discrete electrical circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one integrated circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one application specific integrated circuit, electrical circuitry forming a general purpose computing device configured by a computer program (e.g., a general purpose computer configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and or devices described herein, or a microprocessor configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and-'or devices described herein), electrical circuitry forming a memory device (e.g., forms of memory (e.g., random access, flash, read only, etc.)), electrical circuitry forming a communications device (e.g., a modem,
- a transducer e.g., an actuator, a motor, a piezoelectric crystal
- electro-mechanical systems include but are not limited to a variety of consumer electronics systems, medical devices, as well as other systems such as motorized transport systems, factory automation systems, security systems, and/or communication/computing systems.
- electro-mechanical as used herein is not necessarily limited to a system that has both electrical and mechanical actuation except as context may dictate otherwise.
- electrical circuitry includes, but is not limited to, electrical circuitry having at least one discrete electrical circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one integrated circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one application specific integrated circuit, electrical circuitry forming a general purpose computing device configured by a computer program (e.g., a general purpose computer configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and/or devices described herein, or a microprocessor configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and/or devices described herein), electrical circuitry forming a memory device (e.g., forms of memory (e.g., random access, flash, read only, etc.)), and/or electrical circuitry forming a communications
- a data processing system generally includes one or more of a system unit housing, a video display device, memory such as volatile or nonvolatile memory, processors such as microprocessors or digital signal processors, computational entities such as operating systems, drivers, graphical user interfaces, and applications programs, one or more interaction devices (e.g., a touch pad, a touch screen, an antenna, etc.), aml/or control systems including feedback loops and control motors (e.g., feedback for sensing position and'or velocity; control motors for moving and/or adjusting components and/or quantities).
- a data processing system generally includes one or more of a system unit housing, a video display device, memory such as volatile or nonvolatile memory, processors such as microprocessors or digital signal processors, computational entities such as operating systems, drivers, graphical user interfaces, and applications programs, one or more interaction devices (e.g., a touch pad, a touch screen, an antenna, etc.), aml/or control systems including feedback loops and control motors (e.g
- a data processing system may be implemented utilizing suitable commercially available components, such as those typically found in data computing/communication and/or network computing/communication systems.
- cloud computing may be understood as described in the cloud computing literature.
- cloud computing may be methods and/or systems for the delivery of computational capacity and/or storage capacity as a service.
- the "cloud” may refer to one or more hardware and/or software components that deliver or assist in the delivery of computational and/or storage capacity, including, but not limited to, one or more of a client, an application, a platform, an infrastructure, and'or a server
- the cloud may refer to any of the hardware and/or software associated with a client, an application, a platform, an infrastructure, and/or a server.
- cloud and cloud computing may refer to one or more of a computer, a processor, a storage medium, a router, a switch, a. modem, a virtual machine (e.g., a. virtual server), a data, center, an operating system, a middleware, a firmware, a hardware back-end, a software back-end, and/or a. software application
- a cloud may refer to a private cloud, a. public cloud, a hybrid cloud, and/or a community cloud.
- a cloud may be a shared pool of configurable computing resources, which may be public, private, semi- private, distributable, scaleable, flexible, temporary, virtual, and/or physical.
- a cloud or cloud service may be delivered over one or more types of network, e.g., a mobile communication network, and the Internet.
- a cloud or a cloud service may include one or more of mfrastructure-as-a-service (“laaS”), platform-as-a-service (“PaaS”), software-as-a- service (“SaaS”), and/or desktop-as-a-service (“DaaS”).
- laaS may include, e.g., one or more virtual server instantiations that may start, stop, access, and/or configure virtual servers and/or storage centers (e.g., providing one or more processors, storage space, and/or network resources on-demand, e.g., EMC and Rackspace).
- PaaS may include, e.g., one or more software and/or development tools hosted on an infrastructure (e.g., a computing platform and/or a solution stack from which the client can create software interfaces and applications, e.g., Microsoft Azure).
- SaaS may include, e.g., software hosted by a service provider and accessible over a network (e.g., the software for the application and/or the data associated with that software application may be kept on the network, e.g., Google Apps, SalesForce).
- DaaS may include, e.g., providing desktop, applications, data, and/or services for the user over a network (e.g., providing a multi-application framework, the applications in the framework, the data associated with the applications, and/or services related to the applications and/or the data over the network, e.g., Citrix).
- a network e.g., providing a multi-application framework, the applications in the framework, the data associated with the applications, and/or services related to the applications and/or the data over the network, e.g., Citrix.
- the foregoing is intended to be exemplary of the types of systems and/or methods referred to in this application as "cloud” or “cloud computing” and should not be considered complete or exhaustive.
- ATMs Automated Teller Machines
- Airline ticket counter machines check passengers in, dispense tickets, and allow passengers to change or upgrade flights.
- Train and subway ticket counter machines allow passengers to purchase a ticket to a particular destination without invoking a. human interaction at ail.
- Many groceries and pharmacies have self-service checkout machines which allow a consumer to pay for goods purchased by interacting only with a machine.
- smartphones and tablet devices also now are configured to receive speech commands.
- Speech and voice controlled automobile systems now appear regularly in motor vehicles, even in economical, mass-produced vehicles.
- Home entertainment devices e.g., disc players, televisions, radios, stereos, and the like, may respond to speech commands.
- home security systems may respond to speech commands.
- a worker's computer may respond to speech from that worker, allowing faster, more efficient work flows.
- Such systems and machines may be trained to operate with particular users, either through explicit training or through repeated interactions. Nevertheless, when that system is upgraded or replaced, e.g., a new television is purchased, that training may be lost with the device.
- adaptation data for speech recognition systems may be separated from the device which recognizes the speech, and may be more closely associated with a user, e.g., through a. device carried by the user, or through a network location associated with the user.
- a wearable article (earpiece 167, e.g.) is operably coupled with a handheld device 2760 that includes one or more instances of initiation modules 171, 172, 173, 174 or of response modules 181, 82, 183, 184, 185, 186.
- device 2760 When in use (by user 101, e.g.) device 2760 may be operably coupled via a first channel (comprising a WLAN or other wireless linkage 151 and a wall-mounted device 150 in region 155 and a second linkage 152, e.g.) to one or more other devices in network 190.
- device 276 ⁇ may (optionally) be operably coupled via a second channel (comprising a wireless linkage 161 and a device 160 comprising a vehicle implementing a mobile hotspot in region 165 and a second linkage 162, e.g.) to network 1 0.
- a second channel comprising a wireless linkage 161 and a device 160 comprising a vehicle implementing a mobile hotspot in region 165 and a second linkage 162, e.g.
- Primary device 210 may include one or more instances of a general-purpose central processing unit (CPU) 212 (comprising an internal cache 215, e.g. ); of nonvolatile memories 241, 242, 243 (a phase-change memory 231 or removable memory 232, e.g.); or of volatile memories 261, 262 (a cache 255, e.g.).
- secondary device 220 may include one or more instances of CPUs 222, non-volatile memories 271, volatile memories 272, or configuration units 280.
- One or both of primary and secondary devices 210, 220 may be a tablet computer or smartphone (device 2760, e.g.) with an Android operating system and an antenna.
- 205 configure to facilitate a wireless linkage 295 between them.
- a circuit board 360 includes several integrated circuits (ICs) 361, 362, 363, 364, 365, 366.
- Such formation may be achieved by a series of several lithographic processes (chemical and thermal and optical treatments for applying and treating and etching dielectrics or dopants or other materials, e.g.).
- transistors 351, 352 are linked in a network of signal-bearing conduits 308 (forked or other serpentine signal traces, e.g.) according to intricate circuit designs formed of circuit blocks (initiation modules 171-174 and response modules 181-186, e.g.) of a same general type as those described herein.
- circuit blocks initiation modules 171-174 and response modules 181-186, e.g.
- electrical nodes 341, 342, 343, 344 each having a corresponding nominal voltage level 311, 312, 313, 314 that is spatially uniform generally throughout the node (within a device or local system as described herein, e.g.).
- Such nodes may each comprise a forked or other signal path (adjacent one or more transistors 351, 352, e.g. ).
- many Boolean values may each be manifested as either a "low” or "high” voltage, for example, according to a complementary metal-oxide-semiconductor (CMOS), emitter-coupled logic (ECL), or other common semiconductor configuration protocol.
- CMOS complementary metal-oxide-semiconductor
- ECL emitter-coupled logic
- primary device 210 comprises a circuit board 360 upon which a metamaterial antenna system is constructed.
- a metamaterial antenna system is constructed.
- numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special-purpose circuitry or other structures effective for implementing such antennas for use as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8299967 ("Non planar metamaterial antenna structures"): U.S. Pat. No. 8081 138 ("Antenna structure with antenna radome and method for rising gain thereof); U.S. Pat. No. 8072291 ("Compact dual band metamaterial based hybrid ring coupler"); U.S. Pat. No.
- FIG. 4 shown is another view of the mobile device 2760 introduced in FIG. 1 in which a speaker 442, camera 443, and display 445 (touchscreen, e.g.) are visible. Also within device 2760 as shown is at least an integrated circuit 440 and a power source 441 (rechargeable battery, e.g.). A few of the electrical nodes thereof (comprising pads 435 along the sides as shown, e.g.) provide external connectivity (for power or ground or input signals or output signals, e.g.) via bonding wires, not shown.
- Significant blocks of integrated circuitry 310 on integrated circuit 440 include special- purpose modules 425, 428 (comprising a sensor or other hard-wired special-purpose circuitry as described below, e.g.); and different structures of memory 431, 432 (volatile or non-volatile, e.g.) interlinked by numerous signal-bearing conduits 308 (each comprising an interna! node, e.g.) and otherwise configured as described below. See FIGS. 6 & 26,
- ASIC 540 may (optionally) include a queue 570 (implemented in a volatile memory 272, 432, e.g.) comprising a series of items 571, 572, 573 (data blocks or tasks, e.g.) for handling (by a central processing unit 222 or other core, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which ASIC 540 implements secondary device 220 or SC 363.
- ASIC 540 implements secondary device 220 or SC 363.
- ASIC 540 may include a queue 580 (implemented in non-volatile memory 431 or volatile memory 272, e.g.) comprising a series of items 581, 582, 583 (data blocks or tasks, e.g.) for processing (by a hard-wired special-purpose module 425 or general-purpose CPU 212 configured to execute special-purpose software, e.g.).
- special-purpose modules specifically identified herein may be impleme ted selectively by configuration (in a field-programmable gate array, e.g.) by a. remote device (via a. wireless linkage 162, e.g.) under various circumstances as described below.
- a gate array (comprising integrated circuit 366, e.g.) may implement an FFT module 591, 592 or sorting module 594, 595 or detection module 598, 599 in a manifestation that is remotely reconfigurable. This can occur, for example, in a context in which other such functional implementations (a rarely used FFT module 592, e.g.) are currently either omitted or manifested as software instead (as a module resident in a memory and executable by a core, e.g.).
- Control logic 610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of temperature sensors 608 having a corresponding state 618 (current temperature, e.g.).
- control logic 610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of a general-purpose multimodal cores 635 configured to process instructions in one of the following modes: an "error-tolerant" operating mode 630 (relative to the other modes, e.g.) or a "high- latency” operating mode 631 (relative to the other modes, e.g.) or a "high-performance” operating mode 632 (relative to the other modes, e.g.).
- a multimodal core 635 may also be configured to do nothing (in an "idle” or “off” mode, e.g.) or to operate in some other mode instead (a "normal” mode, e.g.).
- control logic 61 ⁇ may likewise include one or more instances (1 ) of special-purpose circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device 671; (2) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor 672; or (3) of special- purpose circuitry configured to cause a configurable core to draw from a data queue of a particular device 681, 682, 683.
- implementations described herein refer to device-detectable “implementations” such as one or more instances of computer-readable code, transistor or latch connectivity- layouts or other geometric expressions of logical elements, firmware or software expressions of transfer functions implementing computational specifications, digital expressions of truth tables, or the like. Such instances can, in some implementations, include source code or other human-readable portions.
- functions of implementations described herein may constitute one or more device- detectable outputs such as decisions, manifestations, side effects, results, coding or other expressions, displayable images, data files, data associations, statistical correlations, streaming signals, intensity levels, frequencies or other measurable attributes, packets or other encoded expressions, or the like from invoking or monitoring the implementation as described herein.
- a "state" of a component may comprise "available" or some other such state-descriptive labels, an event count or other such memory values, a partial depletion or other such physical property of a supply device, a voltage, or any other such conditions or attributes that may change between two or more possible values irrespective of device location.
- states may be received directly as a measurement or other detection, in some variants, and/or may be inferred from a component's behavior over time.
- a distributed or other composite system may comprise vector-valued device states, moreover, which may affect dispensations or departures in various ways as exemplified herein.
- a "manual" occurrence includes, but is not limited to, one that results from, one or more actions consciously taken by a device user in real time. Conversely an “automatic” occurrence is not affected by any action consciously taken by a device user in real time except where context dictates otherwise.
- "signaling" something can include identifying, contacting, requesting, selecting, or indicating the thing. In some cases a signaled thing is susceptible to fewer than all of these aspects, of course, such as a task definition that cannot be "contacted.”
- "status indicative" data can reflect a trend or other time-dependent phenomenon.
- a status indicative data set can include portions that have no bearing upon such status.
- "causing" events can include triggering, producing or otherwise directly or indirectly bringing the events to pass. This can include causing the events remotely, concurrently, partially, or otherwise as a "cause in fact," whether or not a more immediate cause also exists.
- Some descriptions herein refer to an "indication whether" an event has occurred.
- An indication is “positive” if it indicates that the event has occurred, irrespective of its numerical sign or lack thereof. Whether positive or negative, such indications may be weak (i.e. slightly probative), definitive, or many levels in between. In some cases the "indication” may include a portion that is indeterminate, such as an irrelevant portion of a useful photograph.
- a physical “article” described herein may be a long fiber, a transistor 351, a submarine, or any other such contiguous physical object.
- An “article” may likewise be a portion of a device as described herein (part of a memory 432 or a speaker 442 of a smartphone, e.g.) or a mechanically coupled grouping of devices (a tablet computer with a removable memory 232 and earpiece 167 attached, e.g.) as described herein, except where context dictates otherwise.
- a communication "linkage” may refer to a unidirectional or bidirectional signal path via one or more articles (antennas 205 or other signal-bearing conduit 308, e.g.) except where context dictates otherwise. Such linkages may, in some contexts, pass through a free space medium or a network 190, See FIGS. 17 & 28,
- Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 710 may (optionally) include one or more instances of activation modules 708, 709; of dual-mode cores 711, 712 (each having a lower-voltage operating mode 721 and a higher-voltage operating mode 722, e.g.); or of other cores 731, 732, 733.
- event-sequencing logic 710 (implemented in a circuit, board 360 or ASIC 540, e.g.
- Boolean values 741-745 may also include one or more instances of Boolean values 741-745 or of scalar quantities (a volume 706 or other quantification expressed in a plurality of electrical nodes, e.g.) each expressed as one or more bits. See FIGS. 2, 3, and 20-23 (depicting data-handling media suitable for expressing such individual values digitally, e.g.).
- event-sequencing logic 710 may include one or more instances (1) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision of how many cores to draw simultaneously from a single data queue of a mobile de vice as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the data queue crossing a volume threshold 751, 752 or (2) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of a data queue crossing a volume threshold 761, 762.
- Event-sequencing logic 810 may manifest one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to cause a sorting module in an FPGA of a mobile device to process a data component of a wireless signal after a configuration component of the wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the sorting module 861, 862; (b) of an FPGA 870; (c) of configuration components 881 or data components 882 of a signal; or (d) of event-sequencing logic 710.
- FPGA 870 may be configured or reconfigured to implement a sorting module 875 (a bubble sort utility, e.g.) or other such utility modules as described below,
- a password generation module 986 or other configuration unit 980 (implemented in network 990, e.g.) is operably coupled to event-sequencing logic 910 via a wireless LAN or other linkage 995.
- Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 910 comprises one or more instances (a) of electrical nodes 921, 922, 923, 924, 925, 926, 927, 928; (b) of circuitry configured to obtain via an antenna configuration data establishing a security protocol 931, 932 ; or (c) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to indicate a wireless communication service provided within a region by a device as a response to an indication from another device of the wireless communication service being operative within the region 9 1.
- FiG. 10 shown is an example of a system 1000 in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- Event-sequencing logic 1010 may manifest (as a general-purpose processing core executing software or in an FPGA 870 implemented in a mobile device, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to provide a network access service responsive to whether or not access request data satisfies a security protocol 1021, 022, 1023; (b) of circuitry configured to establish both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device 1031, 1032; or (c) of application modules 1041, 1042, 1043, 1044.
- event-sequencing logic 1010 may include data-handling media 1050 containing one or more instances of commands 1068 or of patterns 1071 , 072 or of protocol
- implementation code 1088, 089 or other device-executable code 1085 may be operably coupled via linkage 1095 with a wide area network 1095 (comprising one or more satellites 1 93, e.g.).
- FIG. 11 shown is an example of a system 1100 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- Event-sequencing logic 1110 may manifest (as a general -purpose processing core executing software or in a mixed-signal or other FPGA 870 implemented in a mobile device, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of capture modules 1121 configured to capture audio clips; (b) of capture modules 1121 configured to capture video clips; (c) of global positioning system (GPS) modules 1122 configured to annotate wireless signals with position data; (d) of speech recognition modules; (e) of text-to-speech translation modules 1124; (f) of digital-to-analog converters 1125, 1126; (f) of decryption modules 1131, 1132 ; (g) of circuitry configured to signal a decision of how much user data to transmit via a communication channel responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the communication channel exceeds a threshold 1141, 1142; (h) of decoding modules 1151, 1152; (i) of comparators 1161, 1162; (j) of aggregation modules 11
- event-sequencing logic 1110 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
- Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 1210 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.
- circuitry configured to receive a wireless signal containing access request data 1201, 1202 ; (b) of circuitry configured to cause a first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not a second device is within a WLA communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device 1221, 222; or (c) of microphones 1217.
- event-sequencing logic 1210 may include data-handling media 1270 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) containing a list 1250 of two or more records 1261, 262, 1263, Each such record m ay include one or more instances of avatars 1251 or other identifications 1252 (representing a person or device known to a user, e.g.); of status indications 1253, 254; or of other such data 1255 as described below.
- event- sequencing logic 1210 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
- Event-sequencing logic 1310 may include various memories 431, 432 or other data-handling media 1350 containing one or more instances of data 1301, 1302, 1303, 1304; of digitally expressed times 1311, 321, 1323, 1324; of signals 1321 , 1322, 1323, 1324; of services 1331 , 1332, 1333, 1334, 1335; or of indications 1341, 1342, 1343, 1344, 1345 as described below.
- event-sequencing logic 1310 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to implement a firewall separating two or more network access services provided via a single device 1371 or (b) of circuitry configured to obtain an indication of a wireless communication service having been provided within a service region 1372.
- such logic may be operably coupled via linkage 1395 with a wireless local area network 1390 (comprising one or more servers 1396, e.g.).
- event-sequencing logic 1310 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
- r n is an example of a system 1400 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- User interface 1410 may include various data-handling media.
- 1450 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) containing one or more instances of decisions 1401, 1402, 1403, 1404, 1405; of results 1411, 1412, 1413; of digitally expressed volumes 1416; of intervals 1421, 422, 1423; of notifications 1425; or of other such expressions 1431, 1432 (comprising sequences 1435 of symbols, e.g.).
- user interface 1410 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to obtain at, one device an identifier of another device 1481; (b) of circuitry configured to signal an availability to participate in a telephonic communication responsive to a Boolean indication of a device being within a wireless communication range of another device 1482; or (c) of circuitry configured to detect an availability to participate in a telephonic communication responsive to a Boolean indication whether or not a device exceeded a boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval 1483.
- user interface 14 0 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- Device 1530 may communicate via linkage 1531 with a vehicle 1510 (optionally implementing a mobile hotspot, e.g.) operated by user 1502 or with a handheld device 276 ⁇ operated by user 2701 (via a WLAN or other wireless linkage 1536, e.g.).
- vehicle 1510 optionally implementing a mobile hotspot, e.g.
- handheld device 276 ⁇ operated by user 2701
- WLAN or other wireless linkage 1536 e.g.
- device 1530 may (optionally) include one or more instances of FPGA 1540 configured to facilitate network management as described below.
- device 1530 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- 816931 1 Wireless transmission system, for vehicular component control and monitoring
- U.S. Pat. No. 8165091 Efficient handover of media communications in heterogeneous IP networks using LAN profiles and network handover rules
- U.S. Pat. No. 8125896 Individualizing a connectivity-indicative mapping”
- U.S. Pat. No. 811 622 Synignal routing dependent on a node speed change prediction
- U.S. Pat. No. 8098753 infrared, touch screen, W- CDMA, GSM, GPS camera phone”
- U.S. Pat, No. 7646712 Using a signal route dependent on a node speed change prediction”
- FIG. 16 shown is an example of a system 1 00 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- Supervisor unit 1630 (instantiated in a vehicle 1510 or other device, e.g.) includes one or more instances of allocation modules 1641, 1642; of detection modules 1671, 1672, 1673, 1674; or of input modules 1681, 1682, 1683, 1684 as described below.
- supervisor unit 1630 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- FIG. 17 shown is an example of a system 1700 comprising a portable or other device 1750 in a communication network 1790 (an ad hoc or mesh network, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- a communication network 1790 an ad hoc or mesh network, e.g.
- Numerous other devices 1752, 1754, 1756, 1758, 1760, 1762, 1764, 1766, 1768, 1770, 1772, 1774, 1776, 1778, 1780, 1782, 1784, 1786 are linked via various passive- media linkages 1771 (through air or cables, e.g.).
- device 1750 may (optionally) include one or more instances of interface modules 1721, 1722, 1723, 1724, 1725, 1726; of response modules 1731, 1732, 1733, 1734, 1735, 1736, 1737, 1738, 739; or of notification modules 1741, 1742, 743, 1744, 1745, 746 described below.
- one or more devices 1754, 786 (implemented as supervisor units having access to one or more databases defining service characteristics pertaining to a local jurisdiction, e.g.
- Such adjustments can be used for congestion relief (during peak usage times, e.g.), for example, or for other resource management as described herein, in some contexts, for example, such devices 1750 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- an FPGA 1 20 may be configured or reconfigured to include a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module 1823 or other event- sequencing stractures as described below.
- FFT Fast Fourier Transform
- event-sequencing logic 1810 may locally manifest one or more instances of circuitry configured to cause an FFT module in an FPGA of a mobile device to process a data component of a wireless signal after a configuration component of another wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module 1881, 1882.
- Device 1910 instantiated in one or more devices 1754, 1764 of network 1790, e.g.
- Device 1910 may include one or more instances of key press events 1931, 1932 or other such user input 1940 (manifested digitally, e.g.); of interpersonal commu ications 1961, 1962, 1963 (calls 19S1 or sessions 1952 or dialogs 1953, e.g.); of registration modules 1971, 1972, 1973, 1974; or of aggregation modules 1981, 1982,
- Such devices 1910 may be operably coupled via a wireless or other linkage 1995 with telephone network 1990 (comprising one or more telephone switches 1996, e.g.).
- such devices 1910 may comprise one or more antennas 1905 (parabolic or shortwave or whip or Yagi-Uda or metamaterial antennas, for example, instantiated in FIG, 17 mechanically coupled with most or all of devices 1750, 1752, 1754, 1756, 1758, 1760, 1762, 1764, 1766, 1768, 1770, 1772, 1774, 1776, 1778, 1780, 1782, 784, 1786).
- device 1910 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- One or more media 2110 may contain one or more instances of digitally expressed fractions 2011, 2012; of configuration data 2015; of coordinates 2021, 2022; of passwords 2035, 2036 or other access codes 2031 , 2032; of signals 2051, 2052, 2053, 2054, 2 ⁇ 55, 2056, 2057, 2058, 2059; of indications 2071, 2072, 2073, 2074, 2 ⁇ 75, 2076, 2077, 2078, 2079; of thresholds 2081, 2082, 2083, 2 ⁇ 84, 2085, 2086, 2087, 2088, 2 ⁇ 89; of clips 2090 (of video or audio data, e.g.); or of rates 2091 , 2092, 2 ⁇ 93, 2094, 2095, 2096.
- One or more memories or other media 2110 may contain one or more instances of indicators 2102, 2103; of series 2125 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 of auditory data 2120 (primarily having been obtained via a microphone, e.g.); or of series 2135 of data blocks 2131, 2132, 2133 of encrypted data 2130.
- Other user data 2150 of interest for present purposes may (optionally) include other encrypted data 2130, video or other image data; or computational modeling data (pertaining to meteorology or research, e.g.).
- One or more memories or other media 2210 may comprise one or more instances of informational models 2301; of images 2251; of decisions 2221, 2222, 2223, 2224, 2225, 2226, 2227, 2228; of indications 2271, 2272, 2273, 2274, 2275, 2276, 2277, 2278, 2279; of services 2281, 2282, 2283, 2284; of phone numbers 2285 or other such identifiers 2286; of percentages 2291, 2292, 2293; of hardware description language (HDL or VHDL, e.g.) expressions 2296, 2297; or of counts 2298, 2299.
- Image 2251 depicts virtual regions 2255, 2265 relating to actual regions 155, 165 as generally described below (with reference to FIG, 1, e.g.).
- One or more memories or other media 2310 may comprise one or more instances of informational models 2301; of status data 2320; of maps 2330 or segments 2337 thereof; or of versions 2361, 2362, 2363 (of an image or other expression of model 2301, e.g.).
- status data may (optionally) include one or more records 2327, 2328, 2329 each comprising one or more expressions (1 ) of times 2311, (2) of positions 2312, or (3) of shape-descriptive information 2313 relating to one or more wireless service regions or devices.
- zones 2351, 2352, 2353, 2354, 2355, 2356 are shown. Some zones 2351 , 2354, 2355 together form a circular region centered at position 2341, containing several identified positions 2347, 2348, 2349, and having a radius 2345 representing a real-world radius on the order (within an order of magnitude) of ten meters or of one kilometer.
- Another version 2362 depicts position 2349 outside a region (comprising zones 2352, 2354) of service 1331.
- Another version 2363 depicts position 2349 within a region (comprising zones 2351 , 2352, 2354, 2355) of service 1331 but not within an overlapping region (comprising zones 2353, 2355) of service 1332.
- Such versions depict various states (including Wi-Fi service outages, e.g.), modes of model updates, or cost- indicative depictions of such services as generally described below (with reference to FIG. 31, e.g.).
- Event-sequencing logic 2410 may bear (as a digital expression, e.g.) one or more instances of decryption code 2425 or signals 2430.
- event-sequencing logic 2410 includes one or more digital or analog speedometers 2420 (instantiated in one or more vehicles 1510 or other mobile devices 160, 2760, e.g.), for example, such signals may comprise data indicating a ground speed or a geographic position (of GPS module 1122 or other event-sequencing logic 1110, 2410, e.g.).
- such signals may include one or more instances of control parameters 2431 or of data segments 2432, 2433, 2434 (user data, e.g.).
- event-sequencing logic 2410 instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1772 of network 1790, e.g.
- event-sequencing logic 2410 may manifest (in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal 2471 , 2472 or (b) of circuitry configured to cause first content of a wireless signal to pass through a first memory of an integrated circuit if second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion and otherwise to cause the first content to pass through a second memory of the integrated circuit 2481, 2482.
- Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 2510 may include (in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to detect a series of service region departure events 2501; (b) of circuitry configured to implement a specific positional model that represents both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator 2502; (c) of circuitry configured to decrease a dataflow through a wireless communication channel incrementally 2503; (d) of circuitry remote from a user configured to signal a result via a device local to the user 2504; (e) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel 2505; (f of circuitry configured to transmit user data
- Detection unit 2610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of processing modules 2641, 2642, 2643, 2644; of configuration modules 2671, 2672, 2673, 2674, 2675, 2676, 2677, 2678; or of a charging sensor 2607 configured to indicate a charging state 26 7 (as a Boolean or digital scalar expression, e.g.) of a battery 2615.
- detection unit 2610 may manifest (on a circuit board 360 or as software executed by a processing core, e.g.) one or more instances of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to draw from a first data queue in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2681 or of circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2682, n some contexts, for example, detection unit 2610 may be implemented in or operably coupled with a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
- FiG. 27 shown is an example of a system 2700 in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
- At least two parallel communication channels 2770, 2780 are established between endpoint devices 2750, 2760 so that an interpersonal communication can occur between device users 15 ⁇ 1, 2701.
- a signal 2758 can travel via linkage 2768 and via one or more intermediate devices 2781, 2782 comprising channel 2780.
- ASIC 540 may be configured either (a) so that channel 2770 includes queue 570 and so that channel 2780 includes queue 580 or (b) so that two or more channels 2770, 2780 are simultaneously processed each through a respective integrated circuit (instances of gate arrays or other IC's 365, 366 mounted on circuit board 360, e.g.).
- Operation 28 describes establishing both a wireless communication channel via a. first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device (e.g. initiation modules 171, 172 respectively creating parallel communication channels 2770, 2780 from device 2760, each including at least one wireless linkage 2767, 2768).
- a third device e.g. initiation modules 171, 172 respectively creating parallel communication channels 2770, 2780 from device 2760, each including at least one wireless linkage 2767, 2768.
- such channels 2770, 2780 may both bear digitized auditory data 2120 simultaneously, optionally including a particular component of user data 2150 (block 2123, e.g.) passing simultaneously through a primary channel 2770 (as signal 2757, e.g.) and redundantly through another channel 2780 (as signal 2758, e.g.).
- Operation 32 describes signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a. data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold (e.g. allocation module 1641 causing one or more transmission modules 1181, 1182 to increase a fraction 2012 of digitized auditory data 2120 transmitted via channel 2780 as an incremental response to an indication 2076 that a data block delivery failure rate 2091 of channel 2770 exceeds a threshold 2081), This can occur, for example, in a context in which the incremental response causes a.
- a failure rate threshold e.g. allocation module 1641 causing one or more transmission modules 1181, 1182 to increase a fraction 2012 of digitized auditory data 2120 transmitted via channel 2780 as an incremental response to an indication 2076 that a data block delivery failure rate 2091 of channel 2770 exceeds a threshold 2081
- data block delivery failure rate 2091 describes a percentage 2291 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 transmitted via linkage 2767 that do not pass via an antenna of device 2771 or that do not reach device 2750 within a permissible latency threshold 2082; in which a volatile memory 262 of supervisor unit 1630 (instantiated in one or more devices 1766, 1772 of network 1790, e.g.) implements several media 2010, 2110, 2210 as described above; and in which such wireless communication channel allocations would otherwise be made in a crude or unduly computation-intensive fashion (by conventional signal strength or load balancing or bit error rate indicia, e.g. ).
- a latency threshold 2082 for digitized voice data communication routing may be less than 0.5 seconds and the effective threshold 2081 applied to data block delivery failure rate 2091 may be less than 5%.
- one or both such thresholds 2081 , 2082 may effectively depend upon an indication 2 ⁇ 75 of one or more attributes of channel 2780 (a data block delivery failure rate 2092 of linkage 2768, e.g.) or other such determinants as described herein.
- allocation module 1641 may be configured to close channel 2780 when a traffic volume through channel 2780 becomes low enough (after several iterations of operation 32, e.g.).
- U.S. Pat. No. 8321727 System and method responsive to a rate of change of a performance parameter of a memory
- U.S. Pat. No. 8320261 Method and apparatus for troubleshooting subscriber issues on a telecommunications network
- U.S. Pat. No. 8315(522 Motion adaptive communications device and integrated circuits for use therewith”
- U.S. Pat. No. 831 1579 Multi-mode mobile coniinunication device with motion sensor and methods for use therewith”
- U.S. Pat. No. 8295395 Methodhods and apparatus for partial interference reduction within wireless networks”
- a computer 2810 in an office 2820 includes a display 2815, a microphone 2817, a keyboard, a speaker, and a mouse.
- An identifier (phone number 2285, e.g.) of a remote mobile device 2870 or its user 2880 are available (listed, e.g. ) at computer 281 .
- WLAN wireless local area network
- an interpersonal communication a video chat via displays 2815, 2875 or telephone call, e.g.
- status information concerning mobile device 287 ⁇ is available at computer 2810 even before such communication is initiated.
- Operation 24 describes obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device (e.g. registration module 1971 maintaining a local instance of contact list 1250 within computer 2810 including a phone number 2285 or similar identification 1252 associated with user 2880).
- a second device e.g. registration module 1971 maintaining a local instance of contact list 1250 within computer 2810 including a phone number 2285 or similar identification 1252 associated with user 2880.
- Operation 30 describes causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device (e.g. notification module 1744 triggering computer 2810 to display a positive status indication 1254 signifying that mobile device 2870 is within a wireless IAN communication range 2866 without first establishing a telephone call 1951 or similar bidirectional interpersonal communication 1961 between computer 2810 and mobile device 2870).
- notification module 1744 triggering computer 2810 to display a positive status indication 1254 signifying that mobile device 2870 is within a wireless IAN communication range 2866 without first establishing a telephone call 1951 or similar bidirectional interpersonal communication 1961 between computer 2810 and mobile device 2870.
- wireless LAN communication range 2866 is established as an operating range of one or more WLAN devices (wireless LAN router 2860, e.g.): in which display 2815 presents such an indication 1254 in conjunction with other information about, user 2880 (in record 1261, e.g.); in which a user 101 of computer 2810 can initiate a telephone call 1951 or similar interpersonal communication 1961 to user 2880 via computer 2810 in response to one or more such indications 1253, 254; in which such telephone calls 1951 are cost effective (free of charge to user 2880, e.g.) and in which user 2880 would otherwise be unable or displeased to participate in such communication (incurring a significant roaming charge, e.g.).
- WLAN devices wireless LAN router 2860, e.g.
- 8037126 Systems and methods of dynamically checking freshness of cached objects based on link status
- U.S. Pat. No. 8010230 Robot ordering and delivery apparatuses, systems and methods
- U.S. Pat. No. 800591 1 Systems for
- a mobile device 2910 (a
- communication-enabled vehicle 1510 or handheld device meanders along a path 2901 through a series of positions 2903, 2904, 2905, 2906, 2907, 2908, 2909 at each of which there is an apparent wirel ess service boundary 2961, 2971, 2981.
- devices that provide the wireless service zones 2960, 2970, 2980 in a region 2955 are unknown or unavailable or transient (by hot spot movements or intermittencies, e.g.), a rate at which some such crossings occur constitutes a useful availability determinant as described belo w.
- Operation 27 describes obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour (e.g. detection module 1671 generating a comparison result 1411 as a direct or indirect Boolean indication 2271 that a maximum crossing rate threshold 2084 was greater than an average rate 2094 at which device 2910 had apparently crossed wireless service zone boundaries 2961, 2971, 2981 in a region 2955 during a particular time interval 1421).
- detection module 1671 generating a comparison result 1411 as a direct or indirect Boolean indication 2271 that a maximum crossing rate threshold 2084 was greater than an average rate 2094 at which device 2910 had apparently crossed wireless service zone boundaries 2961, 2971, 2981 in a region 2955 during a particular time interval 1421).
- aggregation module 1171 has received a series of several indications 2071, 2072, 2073, 2074 of crossing events; in which one or more of such indications 2071 was not "qualifying" (because it did not pertain to an event within time interval 1421, e.g.); in which time interval 1421 is on the order of a second or of a minute; and in which detection module 1671 (comprising comparator 1161, e.g.) compares a count 2299 of such other indications 2072, 2073, 2074 with threshold 2084.
- threshold 2084 is four, for example, a count 2299 of three crossings (e.g.
- detection module 1671 may generate a positive indication 2271 (signifying frequent crossings, e.g.) by applying a nominal threshold 2084 of two against a count 2299 of three (signifying registration module 1974 detecting departure events at position 2905 from zone 2970 and at position 2908 from zone 2980 and at, position 2909 from zone 2970, e.g.).
- Other variants of detection module 1671 may perform, operation 27 using a variety of protocols.
- crossing rate threshold 2084 may be effectively adapted by applying one or more offsets or multipliers to count 2299, for example, or by including other quantitative modifiers as described herein.
- detection module 1671 may implement conjunctive determinants (a Boolean value 744 configured to enable indication 2271 conditionally, e.g.); disjunctive determinants (a Boolean value 745 configured to override indication 2271 conditionally, e.g.); or other such modes of implementing comparisons as indicated herein.
- Operation 33 describes signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device (e.g.
- notification module 1743 causing a headset or display 2875 to provide a user 1502, 2880 with an automatic and conditional decision 1404 as to whether or not device 2910 is currently available to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication 1962).
- device 2910 is the "first" device; in which device 160 is the "second” device; in which wireless service zone 2960 comprises a wireless communication range of device 160; in which decision 1404 will be positive (signaling availability, e.g.) if device 2910 remains continuously within wireless service zone 2960 for longer than time interval 1421; in which time interval 1421 is on the order of a second or of a minute; and in which much more resource-intensive modeling (requiring frequent monitoring of satellite 1093 by GPS module 1122, e.g.) would otherwise be required to determine whether the first device is currently viable for such a communication.
- Decisio 1404 may (optionally) be signaled by a sound (a chord, e.g.) or by a word ("ready," e.g.) or other displayed symbol (a light-emitting diode coming on, e.g.), for example, or by other such expressions 1431 played or displayed at user interface 1410 (instantiated in one or more devices 1756, 1758 of network 1700, e.g.).
- notification module 1743 may signal a positive decision 1404 by establishing the bidirectional interpersonal communication 1962 (comprising a video chat session 1952 or similar dialog 1953, e.g.), moreover, or may signal a negative decision 1404 by doing nothing.
- Two networks 3080, 3090 are each operably coupled with a communications tower 3085 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 770 of network 1700, e.g.) and with a network access control (NAC) unit 3030 (implementing a wireless router, e.g.) comprising several control modules 3031, 3032, 3033, 3034.
- NAC network access control
- One such control module 3031 interacts with device 2750 and conditionally provides a first network access service (to network 3080, e.g.).
- One or more other devices (computer 3060, e.g.) are likewise conditionally provided (by one or more other corresponding control modules 3034, e.g.) with network access service(s) as described below.
- Operation 26 describes obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol (e.g. input module 1684 receiving via one or more linkages 295, 995 a secure access code 2031 effectively deeming one or more data patterns 1071 to be "acceptable").
- a first security protocol e.g. input module 1684 receiving via one or more linkages 295, 995 a secure access code 2031 effectively deeming one or more data patterns 1071 to be "acceptable”
- secondary device 220 includes data storage medium 2010 (non-volatile memory 271, e.g.); in which such linkages include a signal-bearing conduit (an antenna 205, 1905 or optical cable, e.g.) as the "first" device, via which configuration unit 980 transmits access code 2031 to supervisor unit 1630; and in which access code 2031 includes a current password 2035 provided by password generation module 986.
- data storage medium 2010 non-volatile memory 271, e.g.
- linkages include a signal-bearing conduit (an antenna 205, 1905 or optical cable, e.g.) as the "first" device, via which configuration unit 980 transmits access code 2031 to supervisor unit 1630; and in which access code 2031 includes a current password 2035 provided by password generation module 986.
- a secondary device 220 remote from supervisor unit 1630 may be configured to perform such transmissions regularly (daily, e.g.).
- one or more instances of configuration unit 980 may implement an initial security-protocol- implementing data pattern 1071 (during manufacture of supervisor unit 1630, e.g.) for limiting access to one or more services 2281, 2282 (network resources, e.g.) prior to any reconfiguration of supervisor unit, 1630.
- Operation 29 describes obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data (e.g. interface module 1721 receiving a wireless signal 1323 containing access request, data 1301).
- a wireless signal containing access request data e.g. interface module 1721 receiving a wireless signal 1323 containing access request, data 1301.
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which primary device 210 includes event-sequencing logic 1010, 310 (instantiated in one or more devices 1782, 784 of network 1700, e.g.
- the "second” device is an antenna 1905 operably coupled to device 2750 or to NAC unit 3030 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1768, 774 of network 1790, e.g.); and in which device 2750 transmits wireless signal 1323 as a response to input 1940 (key press events 1931 , 1932 or voice commands 1068, e.g.) from user 2701 (initiating a telephone call 1951, e.g.).
- device 2750 may transmit access request data 1301
- Operation 31 describes signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol (e.g. registration module 1972 signaling a decision 1401 to provide device 2750 with a service 1333 that includes access to network 3080 via control module 3031 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1041 determining that access request data 1301 matches security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1071).
- registration module 1972 signaling a decision 1401 to provide device 2750 with a service 1333 that includes access to network 3080 via control module 3031 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1041 determining that access request data 1301 matches security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1071.
- Operation 35 describes signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service (e.g. allocation module 1642 signaling a conditional decision 1402 not to provide an entity that transmits access request data 1301 with a service 1334 that includes access to network 3090 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1042 determining that access request data 1301 does not match security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1072).
- allocation module 1642 signaling a conditional decision 1402 not to provide an entity that transmits access request data 1301 with a service 1334 that includes access to network 3090 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1042 determining that access request data 1301 does not match security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1072.
- control module 3032 may implement the firewall between the "first" and “second” network access services (access to networks 3080, 3090 respectively, e.g.).
- control module 3033 may be remotely configurable (implemented in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or non-volatile memory 243, e.g.) to permit an adjustment of the location of the firewall or otherwise control an allocation of resources i AC unit 3030.
- router 3101 provided WLAN or other wireless service to any devices 3180 (communication-enabled vehicles 1510 or handheld devices, e.g.) that were within zone 3121
- Other routers 3102, 3103 in the region 3155 provide ongoing wireless service within respective disjoint zones 3122, 3123 as shown, and both continue to communicate with network 3190
- Another device 3160 obtains wireless service status versions 3162, 3163 (indicating service availability within zone 3121, e.g.) with corresponding timing data 3165 as described below.
- Operation 25 describes obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time (e.g. aggregation module 1981 receiving a notification 1425 that mobile device 3180 was at coordinates 2021, 2022 three weeks ago at which time a wireless service 2283 had been established between device 3180 and network 3190 via router 3101). This can occur, for example, in a context in which FIG.
- the "earlier" time in which the "first" service region comprises either zone 3121 or a subset of it that excludes zone 3122; in which router 3101 is the "first" device (instantiated in one or more devices 1768, 1770 of network 1790, e.g.); in which notification 1425 arrived at, aggregation module 1981 almost three weeks ago; in which aggregation module 1981 maintains status data 2320 about the availability of wireless services within a region 3155 depicted by map 2330; and in which status data 2320 includes an estimated position 2341 of router 3101 (determined by a detection module 1672 using GPS or other tri angulation protocols, e.g.) at the earlier time 1311 (three weeks ago, e.g.).
- timing data 3165 (derived from a signal 1322 from an instance of device 3180 traveling across zones 3121-3123 and maintained in status data 2320, e.g.) may indicate that as of three weeks ago, service 1331 was operative in zones 3121, 3122 and service 1332 was operative in zone 3123,
- status data 2320 may (optionally) include indications 2278, 2279 of "latest" wireless service status in several zones 2351-2355 near the most-recent estimated position 2341 of router 3101.
- Operation 34 describes signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first sen'ice region or not at a later time (e.g. response module 185 communicating to user 101 a decision 1403 that is responsive to a recent indication 2275 from device 2870 about, one or more wireless services 1331 being operative or inoperative within zone 3121).
- response module 185 communicating to user 101 a decision 1403 that is responsive to a recent indication 2275 from device 2870 about, one or more wireless services 1331 being operative or inoperative within zone 3121.
- mobile device 2870 is the "second” device and has transmitted a signal 1323 at the "later" time 1313 (yesterday, e.g.) from within zones 3121, 3122 (corresponding roughly to map position 2347, e.g.
- such a decision 1403 will dictate whether device 2760 will display image version 2362 (negatively indicative of service 1331 at position 2349, e.g.) or image version 2363 (positively indicative of service 1331 at position 2349, e.g.).
- such signals from various devices 160, 2760, 2870, 3180 traversing region 3155 may be used (1) by a response module 181 configured to determine an indication 1341 of an approximate range of each router 3101- 3103; (2) by a response module 182 configured to determine an indication 1342 of what times of the day or week one of the routers 3102 goes offline; (3) by a response module 183 configured to determine a Boolean indication 2273 whether or not one of the routers 3101 appears to be stationary; (4) by a response module 184 configured to determine a Boolean indication 2272 of whether or not one of the routers 3103 (instantiated in one or more devices 1784, 1786 of network 1700, e.g.) is substantially isotropic; (5) by a response module 186 configured to display via a map 2330 of a user interface 1410 a cost-indicative service boundary relating to a prospective interpersonal communication 1963 via. the user interface 1410; or (6) to perform such functions upon other devices described herein.
- one or more of operations 3754, 3755, 3757, 3758 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or othenvise in conjunction with any of operations 24-35 described above.
- Operation 3754 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device (e.g. response module 1735 routing some or all of wireless signal 1324 to a special- purpose video data processing module 2642 unless and until an indication 1343 is received that temperature sensor 6 ⁇ 8 exceeds a threshold).
- a handheld device 2760 implements control logic 610 and other event-sequencing logic 1110, 1350; in which comparator 1162 is configured to determine whether a temperature-indicative signal 2051 therefrom exceeds threshold 2083 and to transmit a Boolean result 1413 of the comparison to response module 1735; in which threshold 2083 is calibrated so that the effective temperature threshold is 47°C; and in which an extended use of processing module 2642 would othenvise make it
- device 2760 may implement device 1750.
- an instance of application module 1043 may be implemented in a server 1396 remote from handheld device 2760 and configured to perform operation 3754 remotely (by controlling how much data 1303, 1304 to include in a wireless signal 1324 as a function of the state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 residing in handheld device 2760, e.g.).
- an application module 1043 can effectively cause handheld device 2760 to cool down remotely (by deactivating or slowing operations in one or more processing modules 2641, 2642 aboard handheld device 2760, e.g.) without wasting transmission bandwidth.
- operation 3754 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 671 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 3S2 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special -purpose module in a handheld device 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 in the handheld device 2760,
- an event-sequencing structure an instance of numerous transistors 351, 3S2 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.
- Operation 3755 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device (e.g. response module 1736 causing one or more segments 2432-2434 of a wireless signal 2430 to be handled by a special-purpose processing module 2644 in a portable detection unit, 2610 as an automatic and conditional response to a sufficient charging state 2617 of a battery 2615).
- response module 1736 causing one or more segments 2432-2434 of a wireless signal 2430 to be handled by a special-purpose processing module 2644 in a portable detection unit, 2610 as an automatic and conditional response to a sufficient charging state 2617 of a battery 2615.
- detection unit 2610 comprises a portable device 1750; in which at least some segments 2434 include coordinates 2021, 2022 in a virtual reality space (game data, e.g.); in which processing module 2644 comprises an FFT module 1823 or other such special-purpose components implemented in FPG A 1820; and in which real-time rendering in response to coordinates 2021, 2022 or other such processing-intensive functions would not otherwise be feasible in a production-grade portable device 1750.
- operation 3755 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2682 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module 425 in a portable secondary device 220 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1758 of network 1700, e.g.) as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2615.
- a special-purpose module 425 comprises an FFT module 592, sorting module 595, or detection module 599 formed directly on integrated circuit 440 (implementing ASIC 540, e.g.).
- Operation 3757 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a. mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal (e.g. interface module 1724 directing one or more data segments 2431-2433 of a wireless signal 2430 from device 1774 to be processed by a special-purpose decryption moduie 1131 within device 1750 as a conditional response to a control parameter 2431 in the wireless signal 2430 being "10").
- a special-purpose module in a. mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal (e.g. interface module 1724 directing one or more data segments 2431-2433 of a wireless signal 2430 from device 1774 to be processed by a special-purpose decryption moduie 1131 within device 1750 as a conditional response to a control parameter 2431 in the wireless signal 2430 being "10").
- interface module 1724 would direct data segments 2432, 2433 to be decrypted conventionally (by a general purpose central processing unit 212 executing decryption code 2425 resident in internal cache 215, e.g.) in response to control parameter 2431 being "00" or "01” or “1 1 "; and in which the algorithm embodied in such decryption code 2425 would be more readily susceptible to reverse engineering (decompilation, e.g.) than special-purpose decryption module 1131.
- a data segment 2432 may (optionally) include telephonic or other encrypted audio data blocks 2131-2133.
- an initiation module 174 in device 1774 may perform operation 3757 by configuring control parameter 2431 to have a value ("10" or "1 1 ,” e.g.) that causes interface module 1723 to route unencrypted data blocks 2121 -2123 to a special-purpose digital-to-analog converter 1125. This can occur, for example, in a context in which interface module 1723 would direct data segments 2432, 2433 to be converted conventionally (by DAC 1126, e.g.) in response to control parameter 2431 being "00" or "01 ".
- a response module 1737 may be configured to perform an instance of operation 3757 by enabling one or more other response modules 1735, 1736 conditionally, based upon a control parameter 2431 in a received wireless signal 2430.
- operation 3757 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2471 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data segment 2434 of a wireless signal 2430 to be processed by a special- purpose module (FFT moduie 592 or sorting moduie 595 or other detection module 599, e.g.) in a mobile device 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to a control parameter 2431 (access code 2032, e.g.) of the wireless signal 2430.
- FFT moduie 592 or sorting moduie 595 or other detection module 599 e.g.
- Operation 3758 describes causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or through a second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion (e.g. interface module 1722 routing data blocks in a wireless signal 1321 to pass through queue S70 if they comprise auditory data 2120 and otherwise generally to pass through queue 580).
- a first criterion e.g. interface module 1722 routing data blocks in a wireless signal 1321 to pass through queue S70 if they comprise auditory data 2120 and otherwise generally to pass through queue 580.
- wireless signal 1321 also includes a Boolean indication 2102 of whether or not the data
- blocks comprise auditory data 2120, in which queue 570 resides in cache 255 or other volatile memory 262, in which queue 580 resides in phase change memory 231 or other non-volatile memory 242; and in which primary device 210 (instantiated in one or more devices 1752, 754 of network 1700, e.g.) would otherwise need either to provide an ongoing bias current to volatile memory 262 or to incur performance degradation (resulting from excessive interaction with non-volatile memory 242, e.g.).
- interface module 1722 may be configured to route the data blocks in wireless signal 1321 to pass through queue 570 conditionally in response to a "positive" Boolean indication 2103 (signifying that they comprise encrypted data 2130, e.g.).
- operation 3758 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2481 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data component 881 of a wireless signal 2430 to pass through a less-accessible non-volatile memory 243 of an integrated circuit (primary device 210, e.g.) if a configuration component 882 of wireless signal 2430 satisfies a 1 st criterion and otherwise to cause the data component 881 to pass through more-accessible memory 242 of the integrated circuit.
- a first provides operation 3851 and operation 3852.
- a second provides operation 3855 and operation 3856.
- a third provides operation 3858 and operation 3859.
- One or more of these modes may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
- Operation 3851 describes causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device (e.g. configuration module 2697 causing core 701 to draw from data queue 570). This can occur, for example, in a context in which data queue 570 resides in mobile device 160 and in which items 570 comprise data blocks, response module 1734 transmitting a signal 2052 containing a decision 1405 whether or not to cause core 702 to draw from data queue 570 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 1416 of queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086).
- data queue 570 (a circular buffer, e.g.) resides in a volatile memory 262 ; in which the volume threshold 2086 signifies more than 50% of a capacity of the volatile memory 262; and in which maintaining effective processing throughput would otherwise require a continuous power expenditure through a larger fraction of event-sequencing logic 710.
- operations 3851, 3852 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 751 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311 -314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 2221 of how many cores are to draw simultaneously from a single data queue 570 of a mobile device 1 0, 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 706 of the data queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086.
- an event-sequencing structure an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311 -314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.
- Operation 3852 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold (e.g. response module 1734 transmitting a signal 2052 containing a decision 1405 whether or not to cause core 702 to draw from data queue 57 ⁇ as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 1416 of queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086).
- response module 1734 transmitting a signal 2052 containing a decision 1405 whether or not to cause core 702 to draw from data queue 57 ⁇ as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 1416 of queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086).
- data queue 570 (a circular buffer, e.g.) resides in a volatile memory 262; in which the volume threshold 2086 signifies more than 50% of a capacity of the volatile memory 262; and in which maintaining effective processing throughput would otherwise require a continuous power expenditure through a larger fraction of event-sequencing logic 710.
- operations 3851, 3852 may be performed by a special- purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 751 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 2221 of how many cores are to draw simultaneously from a single data queue 570 of a mobile device 160, 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 706 of the data queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086.
- an event-sequencing structure an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.
- Operation 3855 describes causing a mobile device that includes a field- programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a. configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a sorting module ⁇ e.g. configuration module 2698 transmitting a wireless signal 2053 that includes configuration data 2015 with which a configuration unit 280 in secondary device 220 implements a sorting module 594 in an FPGA (implemented in integrated circuit 365, e.g.).
- FPGA field- programmable gate array
- configuration data 2015 comprises a Very high speed Hardware Description Language (VHDL) expression 2297; in which primary device 210 implements detection unit 2610; in which mobile device 2760 contains a circuit board 360 comprising secondary device 220; in which integrated circuit 363 comprises medium 2010; and in which integrated circuit 364 comprises ASIC 540; and in which linkage 295 spans a free space medium (air, e.g.).
- VHDL Very high speed Hardware Description Language
- such a transmission may trigger a local instance of an event-sequencing structure (a special-purpose configuration module 2698 in configuration unit 280, e.g.) configured to implement VHDL expression 2297,
- Operation 3856 describes causing the sorting module in the FPG A of the mobile de vice to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the sorting modul e (e.g. input module 1681 causing sorting module 594 to process some or all of wireless signal 2054 after the configuration component of wireless signal 2053 causes sorting module 594 to be implemented in the FPGA).
- the sorting modul e e.g. input module 1681 causing sorting module 594 to process some or all of wireless signal 2054 after the configuration component of wireless signal 2053 causes sorting module 594 to be implemented in the FPGA.
- operation 3856 may be performed by a special-purpose input module implemented as circuitry 861 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a sorting module 875 in FPGA 870 to process a data component 882 of wireless signal 2054 after a configuration component 881 of another wireless signal 2053 causes the sorting module 875 to be implemented.
- a special-purpose input module implemented as circuitry 861 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a sorting module 875 in FPGA 870 to process a data component 882 of wireless signal 2054 after a configuration component 881 of another wireless signal 2053 causes the sorting module 875 to be implemented.
- Operation 3858 describes causing a mobile device that includes a field- programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a. configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module (e.g. configuration module 2694 receiving a wireless signal 2055 that includes configuration data 2015 with which a configuration unit 280 implements a Fast Fourier Transform, module 591 in a field-programmable gate array comprising integrated circuit 366).
- FFT Fast Fourier Transform
- configuration data 2015 comprises a hardware description language expression 2296; in which primary device 210 comprises detection unit 2610; in which mobile device 2760 comprises secondary device 220; in which integrated circuit 363 comprises medium 2010; in which integrated circuit 364 comprises ASIC 540; and in which FFT module 591 occupies most of the capacity of the gate array.
- a transmission may trigger a local instance of an event-sequencing structure (a special- purpose configuration module 2694 in configuration unit 280, e.g. ) configured to implement hardware description language expression 2296.
- an event-sequencing structure a special- purpose configuration module 2694 in configuration unit 280, e.g.
- Operation 3859 describes causing the FFT module in the FPGA of the mobile device to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module (e.g. input module 1682 causing FFT module 591 to process some or all of wireless signal 2056 after the configuration component of wireless signal 2055 causes FFT module 591 to be implemented in the FPGA).
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which the mobile device comprises supervisor unit 1630 and in which effective transform function performance would otherwise require either ( 1) a significantly larger general-purpose processing capacity or (2) an FPGA significantly larger than its resident implementation of FFT module 591.
- operations 3858, 3859 may be performed by a special-purpose input module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1881 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause an FFT module 1823 in FPGA 1820 to process a data component 1842 of wireless signal 2056 after a configuration component 1841 of another wireless signal 2055 causes the FFT module 1823 to be implemented,
- a first provides operation 3952 and operation 3955.
- a second provides operation 3956 and operation 3957.
- a third provides operation 3958 and operation 3959.
- One or more of these modes may be performed in preparation for or in response to or othenvise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
- Operation 3952 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from, a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1731 triggering a dual-mode core 711 to draw from data queue 580).
- a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from, a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1731 triggering a dual-mode core 711 to draw from data queue 580).
- event-sequencing logic 710, 910 instantiated ASIC 540 or in one or more devices 1750, 760 of network 1700, e.g.
- implements the first core operating mode as a "positive" Boolean value 743 (as a nominal voltage level less than one volt at electrical node 924, e.g.) and in which dual-mode core 711 is operating in a low-voltage core operating mode 721 (manifesting Boolean value 743, e.g.).
- such triggering may invoice special-purpose circuitry 681 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of transistors and voltage le vel s in one or more integrated circuits, e.g. ) configured to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580.
- event-sequencing structure an arrangement of transistors and voltage le vel s in one or more integrated circuits, e.g.
- Operation 3955 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold (e.g. configuration module 2691 manifesting a decision whether or not to cause the dual-mode core 711 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580 in another core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication 1345 of a volume 706 of data queue 580 crossing volume threshold 2087).
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which the "other" core operating mode 722 is a higher-voltage mode (implementing a
- operation 3955 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operabiy coupled with circuitry 761 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a decision 2222 whether or not to cause an activation module 709 to select and activate a. different core operating mode for one or more cores 733 partly based on Boolean value 743 and partly based on a charging sensor state 2617 of a detection unit 2610 operabiy coupled to event-sequencing logic 710.
- Operation 3956 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1732 directing a dual-mode core 712 to draw from data queue 580).
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which event-sequencing logic 910 implements Boolean value 742 at electrical node 922 (as a voltage level, e.g.); in which ASIC 540 includes event- sequencing logic 710, 910 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 762 of network 1700, e.g.
- such operation may comprise special-purpose circuitry 682 having an event- sequencing structure configured to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580.
- Operation 3957 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular de vice in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device (e.g. configuration module 2692 signaling a decision 2224 whether or not to cause dual-mode core 712 to use a lower-voltage operating mode 721 in processing item 582 as a conditional response to temperature sensor 608 indicating a thermal state 618 hotter than a design threshold 2088).
- configuration module 2692 signaling a decision 2224 whether or not to cause dual-mode core 712 to use a lower-voltage operating mode 721 in processing item 582 as a conditional response to temperature sensor 608 indicating a thermal state 618 hotter than a design threshold 2088.
- threshold 2088 is higher than 43°C; in which temperature sensor 608 is calibrated to implement threshold 2088 by design (lacking any explicit access to thresholds 2081-2089, e.g.); in which device 1750 includes detection unit 2610 and medium 2210; in which ASIC 540 includes control logic 610; and in which such effective processing throughput would otherwise make device 1750 uncomfortable for user 1501 to hold for more than a minute.
- threshold 2088 may be lower than 47°C.
- operation 3957 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 672 having an event-sequencing stmcture configured to signal a. decision 2224 whether or not to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608.
- Operation 3958 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from, a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1733 triggering a multimodal core 635 to draw from data queue 580).
- ASIC 540 includes control logic 610 (instantiated in one or more devices 1760, 1770 of network 1700, e.g.) and in which control logic 610 implements a mode designation decision 2223 of "A" (signifying an error- tolerant operating mode 630 that is faster than operating mode 631 and that runs cooler than operating mode 632, e.g.).
- such triggering may invoke special-purpose circuitry 683 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause one or more dual-mode cores 711 , 712 or other cores 731-733 to draw from data queue 580,
- Operation 3959 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device (e.g. configuration module 2693 acting upon a mode designation decision 2223 of "B" before or while processing item 583 from data queue 580 partly based on charging sensor 2607 indicating a sufficient charging state 2617 and partly based on another Boolean value 741).
- configuration module 2693 acting upon a mode designation decision 2223 of "B" before or while processing item 583 from data queue 580 partly based on charging sensor 2607 indicating a sufficient charging state 2617 and partly based on another Boolean value 741).
- activation module 708 may (optionally) be configured to implement such decision 2223 by switching multimodal core 635 into its high-latency operating mode 631 immediately.
- Boolean value 741 may manifest one or more of a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 (as decision 2224, e.g.) or an indication 1345 of a volume 706 of data queue 580 crossing volume threshold 2087.
- operation 3959 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2681 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a decision 2225 whether or not to cause a dual-mode core 712 to draw from data queue 580 in a higher-voltage core operating mode 722 as an automatic and conditional response to charging sensor 2607 indicating a sufficient charging state 2617.
- one or more of operations 4051, 4053, 4055, 4057, 4059 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
- Operation 4051 describes detecting a series of sendee region departure events (e.g. registration module 1974 detecting occurrences of device 2910 departing from zone 2980 at position 29 ⁇ 8 and from zone 2970 at position 29 ⁇ 9, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 1910 comprises or receives data from device 2910 and in which registration module 1974 could not otherwise detect an unsuitable service availability context (driving through a thicket of noncontiguous service gaps, e.g.) would not otherwise be cost effective to implement commercially. In some contexts, for example, device 2910 can report such departure events some time later (via telephone switch 1996 or when device 2910 comes into a WLAN communication range 2866 of WLAN router 2860, e.g.
- operation 4051 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2501 having an event-sequencing stracture configured to detect status data 2320 that includes indications 2276, 2277 of two or more such departure events. See FIG. 34.
- Operation 4053 describes incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel (e.g. configuration module 2675 causing a somewhat smaller fraction 2011 of user data 2150 to pass via a wireless linkage 2767 as a conditional response to one or more Boolean values 741-745 described herein).
- device 2760 includes event-sequencing logic 1210 (instantiated in one or more devices 1780, 1782 of network 1700, e.g.): in which user data 2150 comprises a series 2125 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 most or all of which were obtained from user 1501 via a microphone 1217, 2817; in which at least a remainder of the user data 2150 comprises a signal 2758 passing through another channel 2780; in which channel 2770 is "wireless" by virtue of having at least one wireless linkage 2767; in which configuration module 2675 causes fraction 2011 to drop by at most about half during operation 4053; and in which such incremental decrease eases congestion in a vicinity of linkage 2767.
- event-sequencing logic 1210 instantiated in one or more devices 1780, 1782 of network 1700, e.g.
- operation 4053 may result, from one or more indications of faster processing of signal 2758 (manifested by one or more Boolean values 742, 743 described herein, e.g.).
- operation 4053 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module 2675 (in supervisor unit 1 30, e.g.) implemented as circuitry 2503 having an event- sequencing structure configured to decrease a data flow rate 2095 through linkage 151 incrementally (by an incremental adjustment to a voice sampling rate 2096 applied to a signal 2059 from microphone 1217 during a telephone call 1951 , e.g.).
- Operation 4055 describes signaling a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel (e.g. configuration module 2676 transmitting a Boolean decision 2226 whether or not to transmit any user data 2150 via linkage 161 as a conditional response to one or more Boolean values 741-745 described herein). This can occur, for example, in a context in which configuration module 2676 generates decision 2226 by combining Boolean values 741, 742 (with an AND gate or operation, e.g.). In some contexts, moreover, such decision 2226 may be overridden by one or more other Boolean values 743, 744 described herein being positive.
- operation 4055 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2505 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a Boolean decision 2226 whether or not to transmit any user data 2150 via queue 580.
- Operation 4057 describes signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data (e.g. a special-purpose processing module 2643 signaling a decision 2227 whether or not to adjust a latency threshold 2089 for user data 2150).
- a special-purpose processing module 2643 signaling a decision 2227 whether or not to adjust a latency threshold 2089 for user data 2150.
- user data 2150 comprises sequential video or voice data segments 2431-2433 encoded at device 1768; in which segments 2431, 2433 arrive promptly at device 1750 via wireless linkage 1771 but in which segment 2432 is significantly delayed; in which a response module 1738 applies an effective latency threshold 2089 (and an arrival time of one or more other segments, e.g.) in deciding when to treat segment 2432 as lost and to play segment 2433 (via decoding module 1151 and via a speaker 442 or display 445, e.g.); in which device 2760 event- sequencing logic 1110; and in which such playing of segment, 2433 would otherwise occur too late (due to a large latency threshold 2 ⁇ 89 that was previously necessary being maintained unnecessarily, e.g.
- decision 2227 may result in an effective latency being reduced from 0.3 seconds to 0.1 seconds in response to an indication 2078 of a significant bit error rate decrease or to an indication 2 ⁇ 79 of a significant signal strength increase or to other such manifestations of improved channel performance received from one or more detection modules 1673, 1674 described herein.
- operation 4057 may be performed by a special-purpose processing module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2507 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a conditional decision 2227 whether or not to increase the effective latency threshold 2089 (to more than 1 second, e.g.) in response a user's activation of a speech recognition module 1123 (implemented in device 1768 or device 2760, e.g.) so that words are recognized in data segments 2431-2433 there.
- a special-purpose processing module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2507 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a conditional decision 2227 whether or not to increase the effective latency threshold 2089 (to more than 1 second, e.g.) in response a user's activation of a speech recognition module 1123 (implemented in device 1768 or device 2760, e.g.) so that words are recognized in data segments 2431-2433 there.
- Operation 4059 describes comparing a data block delivery failure rate against a threshold ⁇ e.g. detection module 1673 comparing a data block delivery failure rate 2091 against a threshold 2081.
- operation 4059 may be performed by a special-purpose detection module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2509 having an event-sequencing structure configured to compare a data block delivery failure rate against a threshold as described above with reference to flow 3200.
- one or more of operations 4152, 4154, 4156, 4158 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conj unction with any of the operations described above.
- Operation 4152 describes implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator (e.g. aggregation module 1172 generating or updating a geographic model 2301 that includes a record 2327 indicating an approximate position 2341 and radius 2345 relating to a range of router 3101 and also a record 2328 indicating more complex shape-descriptive information 2313 relating to a range of router 3103).
- a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator (e.g. aggregation module 1172 generating or updating a geographic model 2301 that includes a record 2327 indicating an approximate position 2341 and radius 2345 relating to a range of router 3101 and also a record 2328 indicating more complex shape-descriptive information 2313 relating to a range of router 3103).
- record 2327 identifies a round region (approximating the zone 3121 served by router 3101 and having a radius 2345, e.g.); in which record 2328 identifies an oblong region (approximating the zone 3123 served by router 3103, e.g.); and in which model 2301 could not otherwise maintain an accurate geographical distribution of wireless service status in region 3155 effectively on an ongoing basis.
- aggregation module 1172 may update model 2301 (from version 2363 indicating service in zone 2351, e.g.) to a version 2362 showing loss of service at other positions 2349 also.
- operation 4152 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2502 having an event- sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to implement a model 2201 comprising an image 2251 (shown via display 445, e.g.) depicting a region 165 (served by device 160, modeled as an isotropic radiator, e.g.) and another region 155 (approximated as a semicircular map region 2255, e.g.) served by device 150
- an event- sequencing structure an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.
- a model 2201 comprising an image 2251 (shown via display 445, e.g.) depicting a region 165 (served by device 160, modeled as an isotropic radiator, e.g.) and another region 155
- Operation 4154 describes signaling a result to a user via another device (e.g. transmission module 1183 transmitting one or more indications 1253, 254, 1341-1345, 2071-2079 as described herein remotely to a device 2760 held by user 101).
- another device e.g. transmission module 1183 transmitting one or more indications 1253, 254, 1341-1345, 2071-2079 as described herein remotely to a device 2760 held by user 101.
- the result can comprise one or more instances (1) of clips 2090 generated by an audio capture module 1121 or by a video capture module 1121 ; (2) of coordinates 2021, 2022 from GPS module 1122; (3) of textual expressions 1432 of a word from speech recognition module 1123; (4) of decrypted data blocks from decryption module 32; (5) of decoded data blocks 2122 from decoding module 1152; (6) of maps 2330, records 2327-2329, or other
- operation 4154 may be performed by a special-purpose transmission module
- circuitry 2471 remote from user 101 having an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit a wireless signal so as to cause a manifestation of such result(s) as voltage levels (at electrical nodes 921-928, e.g.) via an instance of event-sequencing logic 2410 (and via a speaker 442 or display 445, e.g. ) that is local to user 101.
- an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit a wireless signal so as to cause a manifestation of such result(s) as voltage levels (at electrical nodes 921-928, e.g.) via an instance of event-sequencing logic 2410 (and via a speaker 442 or display 445, e.g. ) that is local to user 101.
- integrated circuit 440 includes event-sequencing logic 2410.
- Operation 4156 describes transmitting user data via an ad hoc network (e.g. interface module 1725 or notification module 1745 routing at least some user data 2150 via one or more wireless linkages of an ad hoc network 1790).
- ad hoc network e.g. interface module 1725 or notification module 1745 routing at least some user data 2150 via one or more wireless linkages of an ad hoc network 1790.
- transmission module 1184 comprises software (resident in phase-change memory 231 or removable memory 232, e.g.) executable by CPU 212 and in which one or more devices 210, 1750, 2760 send or receive such user data 2150 (comprising one or more interpersonal communications 1961-1963, e.g.) as described herein via. wireless linkage 1771.
- operation 4156 may be performed by a special-purpose transmission module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2506 having an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit status data 2320 or other signals 2051-2059 relating to user-owned devices, e.g.) via network 1790.
- a special-purpose transmission module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2506 having an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit status data 2320 or other signals 2051-2059 relating to user-owned devices, e.g.) via network 1790.
- Operation 4158 describes displaying via a mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost-indicative service boundary relating to a prospective
- intercommunication e.g. notification module 1741 causing a map 2330 that depicts a geographic cost transition relating to an interpersonal communication 1 61 with a user 2701 of a remote device 275 ⁇ to be displayed before the communication begins.
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which user 101 views a display 445 that depicts one or more versions 2361, 2362, 2363 of a segment of map 2330 (successi vely, e.g.): in which map 2330 represents one or more such cost-indicative service boundaries as a low- cost-service region (a zone 2353 shown in green, e.g.) bordering a higher-cost-service region or free-service region (a zone 2356 shown in white, e.g.); in which such costs will be incurred by user 101 if the interpersonal communication 1961 takes place; and in which such costs would otherwise (without notification module 1741, e.g.) be incurred without adequate warning.
- one or more such versions 2361 depict a cost transition relating to costs that will be incurred by the user 2701 of the remote device 2750 (a zone 2351 shown in orange bordered by another cost-indicative service boundary, e.g.).
- a zone 2351 shown in orange bordered by another cost-indicative service boundary, e.g. may become available (in a newer version 2363 of segment 2337, e.g.) as a response to user 2701 placing a call to device 2760 (while device 2760 is ringing, e.g.).
- zone 2351 depicted in orange may become available (to user 101, activated by saying "local roaming map” or by pushing a button, e.g.) as a response to user 101 entering user data 2150 (via. a keypad of device 2760, e.g.) that identifies device 2750 (phone number 2285, e.g.).
- operation 4158 may be performed by a. special-purpose notification module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2508 having an event-sequencing structure configured to maintain a regional map 2330 (on server 1396, e.g.) that features one or more cost- indicative service boundaries 2961, 2971 relating to prospective intercommunications via device 2910.
- One or more versions of regional map 2330 may be updated, in some variants, in response to a positional or other status indication (signifying coordinates 2021, 2022 or operability status, e.g.) relating one or more service facilitation devices.
- a positional or other status indication signalifying coordinates 2021, 2022 or operability status, e.g.
- such devices instantiated in one or more devices 1772, 1782 of network 1700, e.g.
- operation 28 may be performed by one or more special-purpose initiation modules implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1031 having an event-sequencing structure configured to establish a first wireless communication channel via linkage 1771 (e.g. including intermediate devices 1770, 1772) and from device 1750 and a second wireless communication channel from device 1750 and via device 1776. This can occur, for example in a context in which such channels both extend to a remote device 1782.
- linkage 1771 e.g. including intermediate devices 1770, 1772
- second wireless communication channel from device 1750 and via device 1776.
- operation 32 may be performed by a special-purpose allocation module implemented as circuitry 1141 having an event- sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 921 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to implement an adjusted target percentage 2293 of user data 2150 being transmitted via linkage 1771 responsive to data block delivery failures of the second wireless communication channel becoming to frequent.
- a special-purpose allocation module implemented as circuitry 1141 having an event- sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 921 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to implement an adjusted target percentage 2293 of user data 2150 being transmitted via linkage 1771 responsive to data block delivery failures of the second wireless communication channel becoming to frequent.
- operation 24 may be performed by a special-purpose registration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1481 having an event- sequencing stracture configured to obtain at primary device 2760 an internet protocol address or other identifier of device 2760.
- operation 30 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as circuitry 1221 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 925 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to cause a primary device 2760 to indicate whether or not device 2760 is within zone 2960. This can occur, for example, in a. context in which the "third" device comprises a. vehicle or mounted device 1530 providing wireless service 1335; in which the WLAN
- the third device may comprise a moving vehicle 1510 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 776 of network 1700, e.g. ) or parked vehicle (comprising device 160, e.g.) providing Wi-Fi sendee.
- operation 27 may be performed by a special-purpose detection module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1483 having an event- sequencing structure configured to detect an availability to participate in one or more modes of telephonic dialog 1953 as a conditionally response to an indirect Boolean indication 2274 whether or not a device 2910 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1780 of network 1700, e.g.) crossed boundaries too rapidl (as a determination of whether an average or other interval 1423 between events exceeded a threshold, said determination being an inverse of Boolean indication 2274, e.g.) within time interval 1421.
- a device 2910 instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1780 of network 1700, e.g.
- crossed boundaries too rapidl as a determination of whether an average or other interval 1423 between events exceeded a threshold, said determination being an inverse of Boolean indication 2274, e.g.
- operation 33 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as circuitry 1482 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 926 at decision-indicative voltage levels operably coupled to detection the module, e.g.) configured to signal the availability to participate in telephonic dialog 1953 in response to a successful communication via router 3101.
- a special-purpose notification module implemented as circuitry 1482 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 926 at decision-indicative voltage levels operably coupled to detection the module, e.g.) configured to signal the availability to participate in telephonic dialog 1953 in response to a successful communication via router 3101.
- an event-sequencing structure an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 926 at decision-indicative voltage levels operably coupled to detection the module, e.g.
- This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2910 is at position 2349 and in which router 3101 is online (providing wireless service 1331
- operation 26 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 931 having an event- sequencing structure configured to obtain via an antenna 1905 (and via a. wireless linkage 995 from configuration unit 980, e.g.) configuration data (a VHDL expression 2297 or password 2036, e.g.) establishing a security protocol (manifested as an event-sequencing structure in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a protocol implementation code 1088 executable by CPU 212, e.g.).
- a security protocol manufactured as an event-sequencing structure in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a protocol implementation code 1088 executable by CPU 212, e.g.
- operation 29 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as circuitry 1201 having an event- sequencing structure configured to receive a wireless signal that includes password 2036.
- device 1750 includes event- sequencing logic 1210 and receives the wireless signal from device 2760 (as the "second" device, e.g.).
- operation 31 may be performed by a special-purpose registration module implemented as circuitry 1021 having an event-sequencing structure coniigured to signal a decision 2228 whether or not to provide a network access service 2284 responsive to whether or not access request data in the wireless signal (password 2036, e.g.) satisfies the security protocol (a watermark or checksum, e.g.).
- a special-purpose registration module implemented as circuitry 1021 having an event-sequencing structure coniigured to signal a decision 2228 whether or not to provide a network access service 2284 responsive to whether or not access request data in the wireless signal (password 2036, e.g.) satisfies the security protocol (a watermark or checksum, e.g.).
- operation 35 may be performed by a special-purpose allocation module implemented as circuitry 1022 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 927 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) coniigured to signal a decision whether or not to provide another network access service 2282, 2283 responsive to whether or not access request data from another mobile device 2870 satisfies another security protocol (e.g. controlling access to one or more other services 2282, 2283).
- an event-sequencing structure an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 927 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.
- another security protocol e.g. controlling access to one or more other services 2282, 2283.
- operation 25 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1372 having an event- sequencing structure configured to obtain an indication 1344 of one or more wireless communication services 1331-1335 having been provided within zone 2970.
- operation 34 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as circuitry 941 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 928 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 1403 whether or not to indicate the wireless
- zone 2970 a device 3160 as a response to an indication 2077 from another device 2910 of the wireless communication service(s) being operative within zone 2970,
- a. signal bearing medium examples include, but are not limited to, the following: a recordable type medium such as a floppy disk, a hard disk drive, a Compact Disc (CD), a Digital Video Disk (DVD), a digital tape, a computer memory, etc.; and a. transmission type medium such as a. digital and/or an analog communication medium (e.g., a fiber optic cable, a waveguide, a wired communications link, a wireless communication link (e.g., transmitter, receiver, transmission logic, reception logic, etc.), etc.).
- a. signal bearing medium examples include, but are not limited to, the following: a recordable type medium such as a floppy disk, a hard disk drive, a Compact Disc (CD), a Digital Video Disk (DVD), a digital tape, a computer memory, etc.; and a. transmission type medium such as a. digital and/or an analog communication medium (e.g., a fiber optic cable, a waveguide, a wired
- This application may make reference to one or more trademarks, e.g., a word, letter, symbol, or device adopted by one manufacturer or merchant and used to identify and/or distinguish his or her product from those of others.
- trademark names used herein are set forth in such language that makes clear their identity, that distinguishes them from common descriptive nouns, that have fixed and definite meanings, or, in many if not all cases, are accompanied by other specific identification using terms not covered by trademark.
- trademark names used herein have meanings that are well- known and defined in the literature, or do not refer to products or compounds for which knowledge of one or more trade secrets is required in order to divine their meaning.
- trademarks referenced in this application are the property of their respective owners, and the appearance of one or more trademarks in this application does not diminish or otherwise adversely affect the validity of the one or more trademarks. All trademarks, registered or unregistered, that appear in this application are assumed to include a proper trademark symbol, e.g., the circle R or bracketed capitalization (e.g., [trademark name]), even when such trademark symbol does not explicitly appear next to the trademark. To the extent a trademark is used in a descriptive manner to refer to a product or process, that trademark should be interpreted to represent the corresponding product or process as of the date of the filing of this patent application.
- a communication management system comprising:
- one or more articl es of manufacture including transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol;
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service,
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device comprising one or more metamaterial elements configured to transmit the wireless signal containing the access request data.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the third device comprising an antenna that transmits the configuration data establishing the first security protocol, the configuration data comprising a password.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the third device comprising a smartphone or comprising a computer.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the third device comprising an integrated circuit chip or comprising a motor vehicle.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device configured to signal a decision whether or not to indicate a wireless communication service provided within a region by a. fourth device as a response to an indication from a fifth device of the wireless communication service being operative within the region, the wireless communication service being the first network access service,
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device configured to display at least some of a map that includes a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective interpersonal communication between the second device and a fifth device.
- the third device including a field-programmable gate array configured to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module,
- FFT Fast Fourier Transform
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the third device including a control module configured as the firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the configuration data establishing the first security protocol being manifested as an arrangement of one or more voltage levels on the one or more electrical nodes.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the decision whether or not to provide the second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the second security protocol being manifested as an arrangement of one or more voltage levels on the one or more electrical nodes.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device comprising a subsystem of a mesh network. 13.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device including a microphone configured to generate user data from a vocalization.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the second device including a speaker configured to generate an audible indication of whether or not a fourth device is available to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication via the third device at least partly based on an indication of the fourth device being within a wireless communication range of a fifth device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture being configured not to transmit data indicating a ground speed of any of the one or more articl es of manufacture.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the one or more articles of manufacture being configured not to transmit data indicating a geographic position of any of the one or more articles of manufacture.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the third device including the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the second security protocol.
- the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
- the first device including the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via.
- the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device, the handheld device being the second device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device, the portable device being the second device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a. mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal, the mobile device being the second device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or thro ugh a.
- second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion, the particular device being the second device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device, the mobile device being the third device;
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via.
- the third device respo sive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA. to implement a sorting module, the mobile device being the third device; and
- FPGA field-programmable gate array
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the sorting module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPG A to implement the sorting module.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to recei ve a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPG A to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module; and
- FPGA field-programmable gate array
- FFT Fast Fourier Transform
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the FFT module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module, the mobile device being the third device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device: and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold,
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device: and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a. decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device,
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for detecting a series of service region departure events.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a. decision whether or not to transmit any user data via. a first communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data passing via a first communication channel in response to one or more channel performance metrics relating to the first communication channel.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for comparing a data block delivery failure rate relating to a first communication channel against a failure rate threshold relating to the first communication channel.
- the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the second device to display an indication of the specific positional model.
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a result to a user via a fourth device, the result being an indication of whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol.
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for transmitting user data via an ad hoc network that includes the second device.
- the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol
- transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for displaying via a. mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the mobile device being the second device.
- a communication management method comprising:
- the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service a d the second network access service.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device, the handheld device being the second device.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal, the m obile device being the second device,
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or through a second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion, the particular device being the second device.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising: the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol includi g
- a mobile device that includes a. field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA. to implement a sorting module, the mobile device being the third device; and
- FPGA field-programmable gate array
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module; and
- FPGA field-programmable gate array
- the FFT module causing the FFT module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wirel ess signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module, the mobile device being the third device.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold,
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first, data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device.
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- CLAUSES further comprising:
- the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
- a communication management method comprising: establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device;
- the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold
- the communication management, method of CLAUSE 58 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
- a communication management method comprising:
- the first device causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
- the communication management method of CLAUSE 60 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
- a communication management method comprising:
- the communication management method of CLAU SE 62 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
- a communication management method comprising:
- the communication management method of CLAUSE 64 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
- one or more physical media configured to bear a device-detectable implementation of a method including at least
- the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
- one or more signal-bearing media configured to transmit a binary sequence manifesting one or more device-executable instructions configured to perform the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES.
- obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
- the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service
- one or more signal-bearing media bearing at least one binary sequence from an event- sequencing structure configured to perform the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Signal Processing (AREA)
- Computer Security & Cryptography (AREA)
- Computer Hardware Design (AREA)
- Computing Systems (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Databases & Information Systems (AREA)
- Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)
Abstract
Structures and protocols are presented for signaling a status or decision concerning a wireless service or device within a region to a network participant or other communication device (smartphone or motor vehicle, e.g.).
Description
COST-EFFECTIVE MOBILE CONNECTIVITY
PROTOCOLS
[0001] All subject matter of the Priority Applications and the Related Applications and of any and all parent, grandparent, great-grandparent, etc. applications of the Priority Applications and the Related Applications, including any priority claims, is incorporated herein by reference to the extent such subject matter is not inconsistent herewith.
TECHNICAL FIELD [0002] This disclosure relates to facilitating connectivity in wireless communications.
SUMMARY
[0003] An embodiment provides a method. In one implementation, the method includes but is not limited to establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data bloclv delivery failure rate of the wirel ess communication channel via. the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold. In addition to the foregoing, other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0004] In one or more various aspects, related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. § 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0005] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the
I
second device and via a third device and circuitry for signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part, of the present disclosure.
[0006] An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product. In one implementation, the article of manufacture includes but is not, limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block del i very failure rate of the wirel ess communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold. In addition to the foregoing, other computer program product aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0007] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions. The instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device and signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
(0008] An embodiment provides a method. In one implementation, the method includes but is not limited to obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second
?
device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device. In addition to the foregoing, other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure,
[0009] In one or more various aspects, related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.8.C. § 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer.
[0010] An embodiment provides a system . In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and circuitry for causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0011] An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product. In one impl ementation, the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device. In addition to the foregoing, other computer program product aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[00121 An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions. The instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device and causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device. In addition to the foregoing, other system
aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure,
[0013] An embodiment provides a method. In one implementation, the method includes but is not limited to obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first, device being within a wireless comm unication range of a second device. (In such contexts, an interval is "recent" if it began yesterday or today.) In addition to the foregoing, other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0014] In one or more various aspects, related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. § 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0015] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and circuitry for signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
(0016] An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product. In one implementation, the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to
obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device. In addition to the foregoing, other computer program product aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0017] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions. The instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour and signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first dev ice being within a wireless communication range of a second device. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0018] An embodiment provides a method. In one implementation, the method includes but is not limited to obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service. In addition to the foregoing, other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings.
and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0019] In one or more various aspects, related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. § 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer, [0020] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system, includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; circuitry for obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not, to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0021] An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product. In one impl ementation, the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal -bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service. In addition to the foregoing, other computer program product aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0022] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes
but is not limited to a computing device and instructions. The instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol: obtaining via. a second device a wireless signal containing access request data; signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and signaling a decision whether or not, to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access sendee and the second network access service. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0023] An embodiment provides a method. In one implementation, the method includes but is not limited to obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a later time. In addition to the foregoing, other method aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0024] In one or more various aspects, related machines, compositions of matter, or manufactures of systems may include virtually any combination permissible under 35 U.S.C. § 101 of hardware, software, and/or firmware configured to effect the herein- referenced method aspects depending upon the design choices of the system designer.
[002S] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to circuitry for obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and circuitry for signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a.
later time. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described i the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure,
[0026] An embodiment provides an article of manufacture including a computer program product. In one implementation, the article of manufacture includes but is not limited to a signal-bearing medium configured by one or more instructions related to obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first sendee region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from, a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not, at a later time. In addition to the foregoing, other computer program product aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0027] An embodiment provides a system. In one implementation, the system includes but is not limited to a computing device and instructions. The instructions when executed on the computing device configure the computing device for obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time and signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a later time. In addition to the foregoing, other system aspects are described in the claims, drawings, and text forming a part of the present disclosure.
[0028] In addition to the foregoing, various other method and/or system and'Or program product aspects are set forth and described in the teachings such as text (e.g., claims and'Or detailed description) and'Or drawings of the present disclosure. The foregoing is a summary and thus may contain simplifications, generalizations, inclusions, and/or omissions of detail; consequently, those skilled in the art will appreciate that the summary is illustrative only and is NOT intended to be in any way limiting. Other aspects, features, and advantages of the devices and/or processes and/or other subject matter described herein will become apparent in the teachings set forth below.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
[0029] For a more complete understanding of embodiments, reference now is made to the following descriptions taken in connection with the accompanying drawings. The use of the same symbols in different drawings typically indicates similar or identical items, unless context dictates otherwise. The illustrative embodiments described in the detailed description, drawings, and claims are not meant to be limiting. Other embodiments may be utilized, and other changes may be made, without departing from the spirit or scope of the subject matter presented here.
[0030] FIG. 1 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented on a city street.
[003 Ij FIG. 2 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented between a primary device and a. secondary device.
[0032] FIG. 3 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented among electrical nodes and transistors of an integrated circuit.
[0033] FIG. 4 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a handheld device,
[0034] FIG. S depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in an application-specific integrated circuit (ASIC).
[0035] FIG, 6 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in control logic.
[0036] FIGS. 7-13 each depict, another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
[0037] FIG. 14 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a user interface.
[0038] FIG. 15 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a stationary device, a vehicle, or a handheld device.
[0039] FIG. 16 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more
technologies may be implemented in a supervisor unit.
[0040] FIG, 17 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a communications network.
[0041] FIG, 18 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
[0042] FIG, 19 depicts another exemplary environment, in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a device that facilitates interpersonal
communications.
[0043] FIGS. 20-23 each depict, an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in one or more data-handling media.
[0044] FIG, 24 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
[0045] FIG, 25 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in circuitry or other event-sequencing logic.
[0046] FIG. 26 depicts another exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented in a detection unit.
[0047] FIG. 27 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
[0048] FIG. 32 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 27, e.g.).
[0049] FIG. 28 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
{00501 FIG. 33 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 28, e.g.).
{00511 FIG. 29 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
{00521 FIG. 34 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 29, e.g.).
{00531 FIG. 30 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
{0054] FIG. 35 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with
reference to FIG. 30, e.g.),
[0055] FIG, 31 depicts an exemplary environment in which one or more technologies may be impleme ted.
[0056] FIG, 36 depicts a high-level logic flow of an operational process (described with reference to FIG. 31, e.g.).
[0057] FIG. 37 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
36) .
[0058] FIG, 38 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
37) .
[0059 ] FIG. 39 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
38) .
[0060] FIG. 40 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
39) .
[0061] FIG. 41 likewise depicts variants of earlier-presented flows (in any of FIGS. 32-
40) .
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0062] In the following detailed description, reference is made to the accompanying drawings, which form a part hereof. In the drawings, similar symbols typically identify similar or identical components or items, unless context dictates otherwise. The illustrative embodiments described in the detailed description, drawings, and claims are not meant to be limiting. Other embodiments may be utilized, and other changes may be made, without departing from the spirit or scope of the subject matter presented here.
[0063] The present application uses formal outline headings for clarity of presentation. However, it is to be understood that the outline headings are for presentation purposes, and that different types of subject matter may be discussed throughout the application (e.g., deviee(s)/structure(s) may be described under process(es)/operations heading(s) and/or process(es)/operations may be discussed under structure(s)/process(es) headings; and/or descriptions of single topics may span two or more topic headings). Hence, the use of the formal outline headings is not intended to be in any way limiting.
[0064] Throughout this application, examples and lists are given, with parentheses, the abbreviation "e.g.," or both. Unless explicitly otherwise stated, these examples and lists are merely exemplary and are non-exhaustive. In most cases, it would be prohibitive to list every example and every combination. Thus, smaller, illustrative lists and examples are used, with focus on imparting understanding of the claim terms rather than limiting the scope of such terms.
[0065] With respect to the use of substantially any plural and/or singular terms herein, those having skill in the art can translate from the plural to the singular and/or from, the singular to the plural as is appropriate to the context and/or application. The various singular/plural permutations are not, expressly set forth herein for sake of clarity.
[0066] One skilled in the art will recognize that the herein described components (e.g., operations), devices, objects, a d the discussion accompanying them are used as examples for the sake of conceptual clarity and that various configuration modifications are contemplated. Consequently, as used herein, the specific exemplars set forth and the accompanying discussion are intended to be representative of their more general classes. In general, use of any specific exemplar is intended to be representative of its class, and the non-inclusion of specific components (e.g., operations), devices, and objects should not be taken limiting.
[0067] Those having skill in the art will recognize that the state of the art has progressed to the point where there is little distinction left between hardware, software, and/or firmware implementations of aspects of systems; the use of hardware, software, and/or firmware is generally (but not always, in that in certain contexts the choice between hardware and software can become significant) a design choice representing cost vs. efficiency tradeoffs. Those having skill in the art will appreciate that there are various vehicles by which processes and/or systems and/or other technologies described herein can be effected (e.g., hardware, software, and/or firmware), and that the preferred vehicle will vary with the context in which the processes and/or systems and/or other
technologies are deployed. For example, if an implementer determines that speed and accuracy are paramount, the implementer may opt for a mainly hardware and/or firmware vehicle; alternatively, if flexibility is paramount, the implementer may opt for a. mainly software implementation; or, yet again alternatively, the implementer may opt for some
combination of hardware, software, and/or firmware in one or more machines, compositions of matter, and articles of manufacture, limited to patentable subject matter under 35 USC 101. Hence, there are several possible vehicles by which the processes and/or devices and/or other technologies described herein may be effected, none of which is inherently superior to the other in that any vehicle to be utilized is a. choice dependent upon the context in which the vehicle will be deployed and the specific concerns (e.g., speed, flexibility, or predictability) of the implementer, any of which may vary. Those skilled in the art will recognize that optical aspects of implementations will typically employ optically-oriented hardware, software, and or firmware.
[0068] In some implementations described herein, logic and similar implementations may include software or other control structures. Electronic circuitry, for example, may- have one or more paths of electrical current constructed and arranged to implement various functions as described herein . In some implementations, one or more media may be configured to bear a device-detectable implementation when such media hold or transmit device detectable instructions operable to perform as described herein. In some variants, for example, implementations may include an update or modification of existing software or firmware, or of gate arrays or programmable hardware, such as by performing a reception of or a transmission of one or more instructions in relation to one or more operations described herein. Alternatively or additionally, in some variants, an implementation may include special-purpose hardware, software, firmware components, and/or general-purpose components executing or otherwise invoicing special-purpose components. Specifications or other implementations may be transmitted by one or more instances of tangible transmission media as described herein, optionally by packet transmission or otherwise by passing through distributed media at various times.
{0069] Alternatively or additionally, implementations may include executing a special- purpose instruction sequence or invoking circuitry for enabling, triggering, coordinating, requesting, or otherwise causing one or more occurrences of virtually any functional operations described herein. In some variants, operational or other logical descriptions herein may be expressed as source code and compiled or otherwise invoked as an executable instruction sequence. In some contexts, for example, implementations may be provided, in whole or in part, by source code, such as C++, or other code sequences. In
other implementations, source or other code implementation, using commercially available and/or techniques in the art, may be compiled/
/implemented/traiisiated/converted i to a high-level descriptor language (e.g., initially implementing described technologies in C or C++ programming language and thereafter converting the programming language implementation into a logic-synthesizable language implementation, a hardware description language implementation, a hardware design simulation implementation, and/or other such similar mode(s) of expression). For example, some or all of a logical expression (e.g., computer programming language implementation) may be manifested as a Verilog-type hardware description (e.g., via Hardware Description Language (HDL) and/or Very High Speed Integrated Circuit Hardware Descriptor Language (VHDL)) or other circuitry model which may then be used to create a physical implementation having hardware (e.g., an Application Specific Integrated Circuit). Those skilled in the art will recognize how to obtain, configure, and optimize suitable transmission or computational elements, material supplies, actuators, or other structures in light of these teachings.
[0070] The claims, description, and drawings of this application may describe one or more of the instant technologies in operational/functional language, for exampl e as a set of operations to be performed by a computer. Such operational/functional description in most instances would be understood by one skilled the art as specifically-configured hardware (e.g., because a genera] purpose computer in effect becomes a special purpose computer once it is programmed to perform particular functions pursuant to instructions from program software).
[00711 Importantly, although the operationai''functional descriptions described herein are understandable by the human mind, they are not abstract ideas of the
operations/functions divorced from computational implementation of those
operations/functions. Rather, the operations/functions represent a specification for massively complex computational machines or other means. As discussed in detail below, the operational/functional language must be read in its proper technological context, i.e., as concrete specifications for physical implementations.
[0072] The logical operations/functions described herein are a distillation of machine specifications or other physical mechanisms specified by the operations/functions such
that the otherwise inscrutable machine specifications may be comprehensible to a human reader. The distillation also allows one of skill in the art to adapt the
operational/functional description of the technology across many different specific vendors' hardware configurations or platforms, without being limited to specific vendors' hardware configurations or platforms.
[0073] Some of the present technical description (e.g., detailed description, drawings, claims, etc.) may be set forth in terms of logical operations/functions. As described in more detail herein, these logical operations/functions are not representations of abstract ideas, but rather are representative of static or sequenced specifications of various hardware elements. Differently stated, unless context dictates otherwise, the logical operations/functions will be understood by those of skill in the art to be representative of static or sequenced specifications of various hardware elements. This is true because tools available to one of skill in the art to implement technical disclosures set forth in operational/functional formats tools in the form of a high-level programming language
(e.g., C, Java, visual basic), etc. ), or tools in the form of Very high speed Hardware Description Language ("VHDL," which is a language that uses text to describe logic circuits)— are generators of static or sequenced specifications of various hardware configurations. This fact is sometimes obscured by the broad term "software," but, as shown by the following explanation, those skilled in the art understand that what is termed "software" is a shorthand for a massively complex interchaining/specification of ordered-matter elements. The term "ordered-matter elements" may refer to physical components of computation, such as assemblies of electronic logic gates, molecular computing logic constituents, quantum computing mechanisms, etc.
[0074] For example, a high-level programming language is a programming language with strong abstraction, e.g., multiple levels of abstraction, from the details of the sequential organizations, states, inputs, outputs, etc., of the machines that a high-level programming language actually specifies. See, e.g., Wikipedia, High-level programming language, http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/High-level programming language (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :00 GMT). In order to facilitate human comprehension, in many instances, high-level programming languages resemble or even share symbols with natural
languages. See, e.g., Wikipedia, Natural language,
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Na.tural_language (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :00 GMT).
[0075] It has been argued that because high-level programming languages use strong abstraction {e.g., that they may resemble or share symbols with natural languages), they are therefore a "purely mental construct" {e.g., that "software" - a computer program or computer programming— is somehow an ineffable mental cons tract, because at, a high level of abstraction, it can be conceived and understood by a human reader). This argument, has been used to characterize technical description in the form, of
functions/operations as somehow "abstract ideas." In fact, in technological arts {e.g., the information and communication technologies) this is not true.
[0076] The fact that high-level programming languages use strong abstraction to facilitate human understanding should not be taken as an indication that what, is expressed is an abstract idea. In fact, those skilled in the art understand that j ust the opposite is true. If a high-level programming language is the tool used to implement a technical disclosure in the form of functions/operations, those skilled in the art will recognize that, far from being abstract, imprecise, "fuzzy," or "mental" in any significant semantic sense, such a tool is instead a near incomprehensibly precise sequential specification of specific computational machines— the parts of which are built up by activating/selecting such parts from typically more general computational machines over time {e.g., clocked time). This fact is sometimes obscured by the superficial similarities between high-level programming languages and natural languages. These superficial similarities also may cause a glossing over of the fact that high-level programming language implementations ultimately perform valuable work by creating/controlling many different computational machines.
{0077] The many different computational machines that a high-level programming language specifies are almost unimaginably complex. At base, the hardware used in the computational machines typically consists of some type of ordered matter {e.g., traditional electronic devices (e.g., transistors), deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA), quantum devices, mechanical switches, optics, fluidics, pneumatics, optical devices {e.g., optical interference devices), molecules, etc.) that are arranged to form logic gates. Logic gates are typically physical devices that may be electrically, mechanically, chemically, or
otherwise driven to change physical state in order to create a physical reality of logic, such as Boolean logic.
[0078] Logic gates may be arranged to form logic circuits, which are typically physical devices that may be electrically, mechanically, chemically, or otherwise driven to create a physical reality of certain logical functions. Types of logic circuits include such devices as multiplexers, registers, arithmetic logic units (ALUs), computer memory, etc., each type of which may he combined to form yet other types of physical devices, such as a central processing unit (CPU)— the best known of which is the microprocessor. A modern microprocessor will often contain more than one hundred million logic gates in its many logic circuits (and often more than a billion transistors). See, e.g., Wikipedia, Logic gates, http://en.wikipedia.org/vviki/Logic__gates (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :03 GMT).
[0079] The logic circuits forming the microprocessor are arranged to provide a microarchitecture that, will carry out the instructions defined by that microprocessor's defined Instruction Set Architecture. The Instruction Set Architecture is the part of the microprocessor architecture related to programming, including the native data types, instructions, registers, addressing modes, memory architecture, interrupt and exception handling, and externa] input/Output, See, e.g., Wikipedia, Computer architecture, http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Computer__architecture (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :03 G MT).
[0080] The Instruction Set Architecture includes a specification of the machine language that can be used by programmers to use/control the microprocessor. Since the machine language instructions are such that they may be executed directly by the microprocessor, typically they consist of strings of binary digits, or bits. For example, a typical machine language instruction might be many bits long (e.g., 32, 64, or 128 bit strings are currently common). A typical machine language instruction might take the form " 1 1 1 1000010101 1 1 100001 1 1 1001 1 1 1 1 1" (a 32 bit instruction).
[0081] It is significant here that, although the machine language instructions are written as sequences of binary digits, in actuality those binary digits specify physical reality. For example, if certain semiconductors are used to make the operations of Boolean logic a physical reality, the apparently mathematical bits "1 " and "0" in a machine language instruction actually constitute a shorthand that specifies the application of specific voltages to specific wires. For example, in some semiconductor technologies, the binary
number "1 " (e.g., logical "1 ") in a machine language instruction specifies around +5 volts applied to a specific "wire" (e.g., metallic traces on a printed circuit board) and the binary number "0" (e.g., logical "0") in a machine language instruction specifies around -5 volts applied to a specific "wire." In addition to specifying voltages of the machines' configurations, such machine language instructions also select out and activate specific groupings of logic gates from the millions of logic gates of the more general machine. Thus, far from, abstract mathematical expressions, machine language instruction programs, even though written as a string of zeros and ones, specify many, many constructed physical machines or physical machine states.
[0082] Machine language is typically incomprehensible by most humans (e.g., the above example was just ONE instruction, and some personal computers execute more than two billion instructions every second). See, e.g., Wikipedia, Instructions per second, ht^://en.wikipedia.org/wild/Instmctions_per_second (as of June 5, 2012, 21 :04 GMT).
Thus, programs written in machine language -■ which may be tens of millions of machine language instructions long -■ are incomprehensible to most humans. In vie w of this, early assembly languages were developed that used mnemonic codes to refer to machine language instructions, rather than using the machine language instructions' numeric values directly (e.g., for performing a multiplication operation, programmers coded the abbreviation "mult," which represents the binary number "01 1000" in MIPS machine code). While assembly languages were initially a great aid to humans controlling the microprocessors to perform work, in time the complexity of the work that needed to be done by the humans outstripped the ability of humans to control the microprocessors using merely assembly languages.
[0083] At this point, it was noted that the same tasks needed to be done over and over, and the machine language necessary to do those repetitive tasks was the same. In view of this, compilers were created. A compiler is a device that takes a statement that is more comprehensible to a human than either machine or assembly language, such as "add 2 + 2 and output the result," and translates that human understandable statement into a complicated, tedious, and immense machine language code (e.g., millions of 32, 64, or 128 bit length strings). Compilers thus translate high-level programming language into machine language.
[0084] This compiled machine language, as described above, is then used as the technical specification which sequentially constructs and causes the interoperation of many different computational machines such that useful, tangible, and concrete work is done. For example, as indicated above, such machine language- the compiled version of the higher-level language- functions as a technical specification which selects out hardware logic gates, specifies voltage levels, voltage transition timings, etc., such that the useful work is accomplished by the hardware.
[0085] Thus, a functional/operational technical description, when viewed by one of skill in the art, is far from, an abstract idea. Rather, such a functional/operational technical description, when understood through the tools avail able in the art such as those just described, is instead understood to be a humanly understandable representation of a hardware specification, the complexity and specificity of which far exceeds the comprehension of most any one human. With this in mind, those skilled in the art will understand that any such operational/functional technical descriptions - in view of the disclosures herein and the knowledge of those skil led in the art -- may be understood as operations made into physical reality by (a) one or more interchained physical machines, (b) interchained logic gates configured to create one or more physical machine(s) representative of sequential/combinatorial logic(s), (c) interchained ordered matter making up logic gates {e.g., interchained electronic devices (e.g., transistors), DNA, quantum devices, mechanical switches, optics, fluidics, pneumatics, molecules, etc) that create physical reality of logic(s), or (d) virtually any combination of the foregoing, indeed, any physical object which has a stable, measurable, and changeable state may be used to construct a machine based on the above technical description. Charles Babbage, for example, constructed the first mechanized computational apparatus out of wood, with the apparatus powered by cranking a handle.
[0086] Thus, far from being understood as an abstract idea, those skilled in the art will recognize a functional/operational technical description as a humanly-understandable representation of one or more almost unimaginably complex and time sequenced hardware instantiations. The fact that functional/operational technical descriptions might lend themselves readily to high-level computing languages (or high-level block diagrams for that matter) that share some words, structures, phrases, etc. with natural language
should not be taken as an indication that such functional/operational technical descriptions are abstract ideas, or mere expressions of abstract ideas. In fact, as outlined herein, in the technological arts this is simply not true. When viewed through the tools available to those of skill in the art, such functional'' operational technical descriptions are seen as specifying hardware configurations of almost unimaginable complexity.
[0087] As outlined above, the reason for the use of functional/operational technical descriptions is at least twofold. First, the use of functional/operational technical descriptions allows near-infinitely complex machines and machine operations arising from interchained hardware elements to be described in a manner that the human mind can process (e.g., by mimicking natural language and logical narrative flow). Second, the use of functional/operational technical descriptions assists the person of skill in the art in understanding the described subject matter by providing a description that is more or less independent of any specific vendor's piece(s) of hardware.
[0088] The use of functional/operational technical descriptions assists the person of skill in the art in understanding the described subject matter since, as is evident from the above discussion, one could easily, although not quickly, transcribe the technical descriptions set forth in this document as trillions of ones and zeroes, billions of single lines of assembly-level machine code, millions of logic gates, thousands of gate arrays, or any number of intermediate levels of abstractions. However, if any such lo w-le vel technical descriptions were to replace the present technical description, a person of skill in the art could encounter undue difficulty in implementing the disclosure, because such a low-level technical description would likely add complexity without a corresponding benefit (e.g., by describing the subject matter utilizing the conventions of one or more vendor-specific pieces of hardware). Thus, the use of functional/operational technical descriptions assists those of skill in the art by separating the technical descriptions from the conventions of any vendor-specific piece of hardware.
{0089] lfi view of the foregoing, the logical operations/functions set forth in the present technical description are representative of static or sequenced specifications of various ordered-matter elements, in order that such specifications may be comprehensible to the human mind and adaptable to create many various hardware configurations. The logical operations/functions disclosed herein should be treated as such, and should not be
disparagingly characterized as abstract ideas merely because the specifications they represent are presented in a manner that one of skill in the art can readily understand and apply in a manner independent of a specific vendor's hardware implementation.
[0090] Those skilled in the art will recognize that it is common within the art to implement devices and/or processes and/or systems, and thereafter use engineering and/or other practices to integrate such implemented devices and/or processes and/or systems into more comprehensive devices and/or processes and/or systems. That is, at least a portion of the devices and/or processes and/or systems described herein can be integrated into other devices and/or processes and/or systems via a reasonable amount of experimentation. Those having skill in the art, will recognize that examples of such other devices and/or processes and/or systems might include - as appropriate to context and application— all or part of devices and/or processes and/or systems of (a) an air conveyance (e.g., an airplane, rocket, helicopter, etc.) , (b) a ground conveyance (e.g., a car, truck, locomotive, tank, armored personnel carrier, etc.), (c) a building (e.g., a home, warehouse, office, etc.), (d) an appliance (e.g., a refrigerator, a washing machine, a dryer, etc.), (e) a communications system (e.g., a networked system, a telephone system, a Voice over IP system, etc.), (f) a business entity e.g., an Internet Service Provider (ISP) entity such as Comcast Cable, Qwest, Southwestern Bell, etc.), or (g) a wired/wireless services entity (e.g., Sprint, Cingular, Nextel, etc.), etc.
[0091] In certain cases, use of a system or method may occur in a territory even if components are located outside the territory. For example, in a distributed computing context, use of a distributed computing system may occur in a territory even though parts of the system may be located outside of the territory (e.g., relay, server, processor, signal- bearing medium, transmitting computer, receiving computer, etc. located outside the territory).
[0092] A sale of a system or method may likewise occur in a territory even if components of the system or method are located and/or used outside the territory.
Further, implementation of at least part of a system for performing a method in one territory does not preclude use of the system in another territory
[0093] One skilled in the art will recognize that the herein described components (e.g., operations), devices, objects, and the discussion accompanying them are used as
examples for the sake of conceptual clarity and that various configuration modifications are contemplated. Consequently, as used herein, the specific exemplars set forth and the accompanying discussion are intended to be representative of their more general classes. In general, use of any specific exemplar is intended to be representative of its class, and the non-inclusion of specific components (e.g., operations), devices, and objects should not be taken limiting.
[0094] The herein described subject matter sometimes illustrates different components contained within, or connected with, different other components. It is to be understood that such depicted architectures are merely exemplary, and that in fact many other architectures may be implemented which achieve the same functionality. In a conceptual sense, any arrangement of components to achieve the same functionality is effectively "associated" such that the desired functionality is achieved. Hence, any two components herein combined to achieve a particular functionality can be seen as "associated with" each other such that the desired functionality is achieved, irrespective of architectures or intermedial components. Likewise, any two components so associated can also be viewed as being "operably connected", or "operably coupled," to each other to achieve the desired functionality, and any two components capable of being so associated can also be viewed as being "operably couplable," to each other to achieve the desired functionality. Specific examples of operably couplable include but are not limited to physically mateable and/or physically interacting components, and/or wirelessly interactable, aml/or wirelessly interacting components, and'Or logically interacting, and/or logically interactable components.
{0095] lfi some instances, one or more components may be referred to herein as "configured to," "configured by," "configurable to," "operable/operative to,"
"adapted/ adaptable," "able to," "conformable/conformed to," etc. Those skilled in the art will recognize that such terms (e.g. "configured to") generally encompass active-state components and/or inactive-state components and'Or standby-state components, unless context requires otherwise.
{0096| In a general sense, those skilled in the art will recognize that the various embodiments described herein can be implemented, individually and'Or collectively, by various types of electro-mechanical systems having a wide range of electrical
components such as hardware, software, firmware, and/or virtually any combination thereof, limited to patentable subject matter under 35 U.S.C. 101 ; and a wide range of components that may impart mechanical force or motion such as rigid bodies, spring or torsional bodies, hydraulics, electro-magnetically actuated devices, and/or virtually any combination thereof. Consequently, as used herein "electro-mechanical system" includes, but is not, limited to, electrical circuitry operably coupled with a transducer (e.g., an actuator, a motor, a piezoelectric crystal, a Micro Electro Mechanical System (MEMS), etc.), electrical circuitry having at least one discrete electrical circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one integrated circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one application specific integrated circuit, electrical circuitry forming a general purpose computing device configured by a computer program (e.g., a general purpose computer configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and or devices described herein, or a microprocessor configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and-'or devices described herein), electrical circuitry forming a memory device (e.g., forms of memory (e.g., random access, flash, read only, etc.)), electrical circuitry forming a communications device (e.g., a modem,
communications switch, optical-electrical equipment, etc.), and/or any non-electrical analog thereto, such as optical or other analogs (e.g., graphene based circuitry). Those skilled in the art will also appreciate that examples of electro-mechanical systems include but are not limited to a variety of consumer electronics systems, medical devices, as well as other systems such as motorized transport systems, factory automation systems, security systems, and/or communication/computing systems. Those skilled in the art will recognize that electro-mechanical as used herein is not necessarily limited to a system that has both electrical and mechanical actuation except as context may dictate otherwise. (0097| In a general sense, those skilled in the art will recognize that the various aspects described herein which can be implemented, individually and/or collectively, by a wide range of hardw are, softw are, firmware, and/or any combination thereof can be viewed as being composed of various types of "electrical circuitry." Consequently, as used herein "electrical circuitry" includes, but is not limited to, electrical circuitry having at least one discrete electrical circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one integrated circuit, electrical circuitry having at least one application specific integrated circuit, electrical
circuitry forming a general purpose computing device configured by a computer program (e.g., a general purpose computer configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and/or devices described herein, or a microprocessor configured by a computer program which at least partially carries out processes and/or devices described herein), electrical circuitry forming a memory device (e.g., forms of memory (e.g., random access, flash, read only, etc.)), and/or electrical circuitry forming a communications device (e.g., a modem., communications switch, optical-electrical equipment, etc.). Those having skill in the art, will recognize that the subject matter described herein may be implemented in an analog or digital fashion or some
combination thereof.
[0098] Those skilled in the art will recognize that at least a portion of the devices and/or processes described herein can be integrated into a data processing system. Those having skill in the art will recognize that a data processing system generally includes one or more of a system unit housing, a video display device, memory such as volatile or nonvolatile memory, processors such as microprocessors or digital signal processors, computational entities such as operating systems, drivers, graphical user interfaces, and applications programs, one or more interaction devices (e.g., a touch pad, a touch screen, an antenna, etc.), aml/or control systems including feedback loops and control motors (e.g., feedback for sensing position and'or velocity; control motors for moving and/or adjusting components and/or quantities). A data processing system may be implemented utilizing suitable commercially available components, such as those typically found in data computing/communication and/or network computing/communication systems. {00991 For the purposes of this application, "cloud" computing may be understood as described in the cloud computing literature. For example, cloud computing may be methods and/or systems for the delivery of computational capacity and/or storage capacity as a service. The "cloud" may refer to one or more hardware and/or software components that deliver or assist in the delivery of computational and/or storage capacity, including, but not limited to, one or more of a client, an application, a platform, an infrastructure, and'or a server The cloud may refer to any of the hardware and/or software associated with a client, an application, a platform, an infrastructure, and/or a server. For example, cloud and cloud computing may refer to one or more of a computer, a
processor, a storage medium, a router, a switch, a. modem, a virtual machine (e.g., a. virtual server), a data, center, an operating system, a middleware, a firmware, a hardware back-end, a software back-end, and/or a. software application, A cloud may refer to a private cloud, a. public cloud, a hybrid cloud, and/or a community cloud. A cloud may be a shared pool of configurable computing resources, which may be public, private, semi- private, distributable, scaleable, flexible, temporary, virtual, and/or physical. A cloud or cloud service may be delivered over one or more types of network, e.g., a mobile communication network, and the Internet.
[00100] As used in this application, a cloud or a cloud service may include one or more of mfrastructure-as-a-service ("laaS"), platform-as-a-service ("PaaS"), software-as-a- service ("SaaS"), and/or desktop-as-a-service ("DaaS"). As a non-exclusive example, laaS may include, e.g., one or more virtual server instantiations that may start, stop, access, and/or configure virtual servers and/or storage centers (e.g., providing one or more processors, storage space, and/or network resources on-demand, e.g., EMC and Rackspace). PaaS may include, e.g., one or more software and/or development tools hosted on an infrastructure (e.g., a computing platform and/or a solution stack from which the client can create software interfaces and applications, e.g., Microsoft Azure). SaaS may include, e.g., software hosted by a service provider and accessible over a network (e.g., the software for the application and/or the data associated with that software application may be kept on the network, e.g., Google Apps, SalesForce). DaaS may include, e.g., providing desktop, applications, data, and/or services for the user over a network (e.g., providing a multi-application framework, the applications in the framework, the data associated with the applications, and/or services related to the applications and/or the data over the network, e.g., Citrix). The foregoing is intended to be exemplary of the types of systems and/or methods referred to in this application as "cloud" or "cloud computing" and should not be considered complete or exhaustive.
[001011 The proliferation of automation in many transactions is apparent. For example, Automated Teller Machines ("ATMs") dispense money and receive deposits. Airline ticket counter machines check passengers in, dispense tickets, and allow passengers to change or upgrade flights. Train and subway ticket counter machines allow passengers to purchase a ticket to a particular destination without invoking a. human interaction at ail.
Many groceries and pharmacies have self-service checkout machines which allow a consumer to pay for goods purchased by interacting only with a machine. Large companies now staff telephone answering systems with machines that interact with customers, and invoke a human in the transaction only if there is a problem with the machine-facilitated transaction,
[00102] Nevertheless, as such automation increases, convenience and accessibility may decrease. Self-checkout machines at grocery stores may be difficult to operate. ATMs and ticket counter machines may be mostly inaccessible to disabled persons or persons requiring special access. Where before, the interaction with a human would allow disabled persons to complete transactions with relative ease, if a disabled person is unable to push the buttons on an ATM, there is little the machine can do to facilitate the transaction to completion. While some of these public terminals allow speech operations, they are configured to the most generic forms of speech, which may be less useful in recognizing particular speakers, thereby leading to frustration for users attempting to speak to the machine. This problem may be especially challenging for the disabled, who already may face significant challenges in completing transactions with automated machines.
[00103] In addition, smartphones and tablet devices also now are configured to receive speech commands. Speech and voice controlled automobile systems now appear regularly in motor vehicles, even in economical, mass-produced vehicles. Home entertainment devices, e.g., disc players, televisions, radios, stereos, and the like, may respond to speech commands. Additionally, home security systems may respond to speech commands. In an office setting, a worker's computer may respond to speech from that worker, allowing faster, more efficient work flows. Such systems and machines may be trained to operate with particular users, either through explicit training or through repeated interactions. Nevertheless, when that system is upgraded or replaced, e.g., a new television is purchased, that training may be lost with the device. Thus, in some embodiments described herein, adaptation data for speech recognition systems may be separated from the device which recognizes the speech, and may be more closely associated with a user, e.g., through a. device carried by the user, or through a network location associated with the user.
[00104] Further, i some environments, there may be more than one device that transmits and receives data, within a range of interacting with a user. For example, merely sitting on a couch watching television may involve five or more devices, e.g., a television, a cable box, an audio/visual receiver, a remote control, and a smartphone device. Some of these devices may transmit or receive speech data. Some of these devices may transmit, receive, or store adaptation data, as will be described in more detail herein. Thus, in some embodiments, which will be described in more detail herein, there may be methods, systems, and devices for determining which devices in a system should perform actions that allow a user to efficiently interact with an intended device through that user's speech.
[00105] With reference now to FIG, 1, shown is an example of a system 100 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. A wearable article (earpiece 167, e.g.) is operably coupled with a handheld device 2760 that includes one or more instances of initiation modules 171, 172, 173, 174 or of response modules 181, 82, 183, 184, 185, 186. When in use (by user 101, e.g.) device 2760 may be operably coupled via a first channel (comprising a WLAN or other wireless linkage 151 and a wall-mounted device 150 in region 155 and a second linkage 152, e.g.) to one or more other devices in network 190. Alternatively or additionally, device 276Θ may (optionally) be operably coupled via a second channel (comprising a wireless linkage 161 and a device 160 comprising a vehicle implementing a mobile hotspot in region 165 and a second linkage 162, e.g.) to network 1 0.
[00106] With reference now to FIG. 2, shown is another example of a system 200 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Primary device 210 (a vehicle or router or integrated circuit, e.g.) may include one or more instances of a general-purpose central processing unit (CPU) 212 (comprising an internal cache 215, e.g. ); of nonvolatile memories 241, 242, 243 (a phase-change memory 231 or removable memory 232, e.g.); or of volatile memories 261, 262 (a cache 255, e.g.). In some variants, secondary device 220 may include one or more instances of CPUs 222, non-volatile memories 271, volatile memories 272, or configuration units 280. One or both of primary and secondary devices 210, 220 may be a tablet computer or smartphone (device
2760, e.g.) with an Android operating system and an antenna. 205 configure to facilitate a wireless linkage 295 between them.
[00107] With reference now to FIG, 3, shown is another example of a system 300 in which one or more technologies may be implemented, A circuit board 360 includes several integrated circuits (ICs) 361, 362, 363, 364, 365, 366. Integrated circuitry 310 within IC 361, for example, includes transistors 351, 352 each formed onto a single dielectric substrate 307, Transistor 351, for example, comprises a control terminal (a gate or base, e.g.) at node 342 and two end terminals (at nodes 341, 343) as shown. Such formation may be achieved by a series of several lithographic processes (chemical and thermal and optical treatments for applying and treating and etching dielectrics or dopants or other materials, e.g.). Many millions of such transistors 351, 352 are linked in a network of signal-bearing conduits 308 (forked or other serpentine signal traces, e.g.) according to intricate circuit designs formed of circuit blocks (initiation modules 171-174 and response modules 181-186, e.g.) of a same general type as those described herein. Even among the relatively complex circuit blocks presented herein in context, however, many such blocks (excluding a variety of components such as antenna 205, e.g.) are linked by electrical nodes 341, 342, 343, 344 each having a corresponding nominal voltage level 311, 312, 313, 314 that is spatially uniform generally throughout the node (within a device or local system as described herein, e.g.). Such nodes (lines on an integrated circuit or circuit board 360, e.g.) may each comprise a forked or other signal path (adjacent one or more transistors 351, 352, e.g. ). Moreover many Boolean values (yes-or-no decisions, e.g.) may each be manifested as either a "low" or "high" voltage, for example, according to a complementary metal-oxide-semiconductor (CMOS), emitter-coupled logic (ECL), or other common semiconductor configuration protocol.
[00108] In some variants, primary device 210 comprises a circuit board 360 upon which a metamaterial antenna system is constructed. In light of teachings herein, in fact, numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special-purpose circuitry or other structures effective for implementing such antennas for use as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8299967 ("Non planar metamaterial antenna structures"): U.S. Pat. No. 8081 138 ("Antenna structure with antenna radome and method for rising gain thereof); U.S. Pat. No. 8072291 ("Compact
dual band metamaterial based hybrid ring coupler"); U.S. Pat. No. 7847739 ("Antennas based on metamaterial structures"); U.S. Pat. No. 7218190 ("Waveguides and scattering devices incorporating epsiion-negative and/or mu-negative slabs"); U.S. Pat. No.
6958729 ("Phased array metamaterial antenna system"); U.S. Pat. App. No. 12/92551 1 ("Metamaterial surfaces"); U.S. Pat. App, No. 12/220703 ("Emitting and negatively refractive focusing apparatus methods and systems"); and U.S. Pat. App. No. 12/156443 ("Focusing and sensing apparatus methods and systems").
[00109] With reference now to FIG. 4, shown is another view of the mobile device 2760 introduced in FIG. 1 in which a speaker 442, camera 443, and display 445 (touchscreen, e.g.) are visible. Also within device 2760 as shown is at least an integrated circuit 440 and a power source 441 (rechargeable battery, e.g.). A few of the electrical nodes thereof (comprising pads 435 along the sides as shown, e.g.) provide external connectivity (for power or ground or input signals or output signals, e.g.) via bonding wires, not shown. Significant blocks of integrated circuitry 310 on integrated circuit 440 include special- purpose modules 425, 428 (comprising a sensor or other hard-wired special-purpose circuitry as described below, e.g.); and different structures of memory 431, 432 (volatile or non-volatile, e.g.) interlinked by numerous signal-bearing conduits 308 (each comprising an interna! node, e.g.) and otherwise configured as described below. See FIGS. 6 & 26,
[00110] With reference now to FIG. 5, shown is another example of a system in which one or more technologies may be implemented comprising a schematic view of an application-specific integrated circuit (ASIC) 540. ASIC 540 may (optionally) include a queue 570 (implemented in a volatile memory 272, 432, e.g.) comprising a series of items 571, 572, 573 (data blocks or tasks, e.g.) for handling (by a central processing unit 222 or other core, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which ASIC 540 implements secondary device 220 or SC 363. Alternatively or additionally, ASIC 540 may include a queue 580 (implemented in non-volatile memory 431 or volatile memory 272, e.g.) comprising a series of items 581, 582, 583 (data blocks or tasks, e.g.) for processing (by a hard-wired special-purpose module 425 or general-purpose CPU 212 configured to execute special-purpose software, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, special-purpose modules specifically identified herein (as circuitry in FIGS. 6-14, e.g.)
may be impleme ted selectively by configuration (in a field-programmable gate array, e.g.) by a. remote device (via a. wireless linkage 162, e.g.) under various circumstances as described below. In some variants, for example, a gate array (comprising integrated circuit 366, e.g.) may implement an FFT module 591, 592 or sorting module 594, 595 or detection module 598, 599 in a manifestation that is remotely reconfigurable. This can occur, for example, in a context in which other such functional implementations (a rarely used FFT module 592, e.g.) are currently either omitted or manifested as software instead (as a module resident in a memory and executable by a core, e.g.).
[00111] With reference now to FIG, 6, shown is an example of a system 600 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Control logic 610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of temperature sensors 608 having a corresponding state 618 (current temperature, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, control logic 610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of a general-purpose multimodal cores 635 configured to process instructions in one of the following modes: an "error-tolerant" operating mode 630 (relative to the other modes, e.g.) or a "high- latency" operating mode 631 (relative to the other modes, e.g.) or a "high-performance" operating mode 632 (relative to the other modes, e.g.). In some contexts a multimodal core 635 may also be configured to do nothing (in an "idle" or "off" mode, e.g.) or to operate in some other mode instead (a "normal" mode, e.g.). As further explained below, in some contexts, control logic 61Θ may likewise include one or more instances (1 ) of special-purpose circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device 671; (2) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor 672; or (3) of special- purpose circuitry configured to cause a configurable core to draw from a data queue of a particular device 681, 682, 683.
[00112| Several variants described herein refer to device-detectable "implementations" such as one or more instances of computer-readable code, transistor or latch connectivity- layouts or other geometric expressions of logical elements, firmware or software
expressions of transfer functions implementing computational specifications, digital expressions of truth tables, or the like. Such instances can, in some implementations, include source code or other human-readable portions. Alternatively or additionally, functions of implementations described herein may constitute one or more device- detectable outputs such as decisions, manifestations, side effects, results, coding or other expressions, displayable images, data files, data associations, statistical correlations, streaming signals, intensity levels, frequencies or other measurable attributes, packets or other encoded expressions, or the like from invoking or monitoring the implementation as described herein.
[00113] In some embodiments, a "state" of a component may comprise "available" or some other such state-descriptive labels, an event count or other such memory values, a partial depletion or other such physical property of a supply device, a voltage, or any other such conditions or attributes that may change between two or more possible values irrespective of device location. Such states may be received directly as a measurement or other detection, in some variants, and/or may be inferred from a component's behavior over time. A distributed or other composite system may comprise vector-valued device states, moreover, which may affect dispensations or departures in various ways as exemplified herein.
[00114| "Automatic," "conditional," "detectable," "handheld," "bidirectional,"
"effective," "employed," "explicit," "in a vicinity," "local," "wireless," "portable," "mobile," "recent," "incrementally," "multiple," "objective," "interpersonal," "ad hoc," "single," "between," "particular," "isotropic," "thermal," "within," "passive," "partly," "prior," "proximate," "associated," "audible," "received," "remote," "responsive," "earlier," "resident," "later," "operative," "selective," "specific," "special-purpose," "caused," "stationary," "between," "matching," "significant," "common," or other such descriptors herein are used in their normal yes-or-no sense, not as terms of degree, unless context dictates otherwise. In light of the present disclosure those skilled in the art will understand from context what is meant by "vicinity," by being "in" a region or "within" a range, by "remote," and by other such positional descriptors used herein. Terms like "processor," "center," "unit," "computer," or other such descriptors herein are used in their normal sense, in reference to an inanimate structure. Such terms do not include any
people, irrespective of their location or employment or other association with the thing described, unless context dictates otherwise. "For" is not used to articulate a mere intended purpose in phrases like "circuitry for" or "instruction for," moreover, but is used normally, in descriptively identifying special purpose software or structures.
[00115] In some embodiments a "manual" occurrence includes, but is not limited to, one that results from, one or more actions consciously taken by a device user in real time. Conversely an "automatic" occurrence is not affected by any action consciously taken by a device user in real time except where context dictates otherwise.
[00116] In some embodiments, "signaling" something can include identifying, contacting, requesting, selecting, or indicating the thing. In some cases a signaled thing is susceptible to fewer than all of these aspects, of course, such as a task definition that cannot be "contacted."
[00117] In some embodiments, "status indicative" data can reflect a trend or other time- dependent phenomenon. Alternatively or additionally, a status indicative data set can include portions that have no bearing upon such status. Although some types of distillations can require authority or substantial expertise, many other types of distillations can readily be implemented without undue experimentation in light of teachings herein.
[00118] In some embodiments, "causing" events can include triggering, producing or otherwise directly or indirectly bringing the events to pass. This can include causing the events remotely, concurrently, partially, or otherwise as a "cause in fact," whether or not a more immediate cause also exists.
[00119] Some descriptions herein refer to an "indication whether" an event has occurred. An indication is "positive" if it indicates that the event has occurred, irrespective of its numerical sign or lack thereof. Whether positive or negative, such indications may be weak (i.e. slightly probative), definitive, or many levels in between. In some cases the "indication" may include a portion that is indeterminate, such as an irrelevant portion of a useful photograph.
[00120] Some descriptions herein refer to a "device" or other physical article. A physical "article" described herein may be a long fiber, a transistor 351, a submarine, or any other such contiguous physical object. An "article" may likewise be a portion of a
device as described herein (part of a memory 432 or a speaker 442 of a smartphone, e.g.) or a mechanically coupled grouping of devices (a tablet computer with a removable memory 232 and earpiece 167 attached, e.g.) as described herein, except where context dictates otherwise. A communication "linkage" may refer to a unidirectional or bidirectional signal path via one or more articles (antennas 205 or other signal-bearing conduit 308, e.g.) except where context dictates otherwise. Such linkages may, in some contexts, pass through a free space medium or a network 190, See FIGS. 17 & 28,
[00121] With reference now to FIG. 7, shown is an example of a system. 700 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 710 may (optionally) include one or more instances of activation modules 708, 709; of dual-mode cores 711, 712 (each having a lower-voltage operating mode 721 and a higher-voltage operating mode 722, e.g.); or of other cores 731, 732, 733. In some contexts event-sequencing logic 710 (implemented in a circuit, board 360 or ASIC 540, e.g. ) may also include one or more instances of Boolean values 741-745 or of scalar quantities (a volume 706 or other quantification expressed in a plurality of electrical nodes, e.g.) each expressed as one or more bits. See FIGS. 2, 3, and 20-23 (depicting data-handling media suitable for expressing such individual values digitally, e.g.). Also as further explained below, in some contexts, event-sequencing logic 710 may include one or more instances (1) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision of how many cores to draw simultaneously from a single data queue of a mobile de vice as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the data queue crossing a volume threshold 751, 752 or (2) of special-purpose circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of a data queue crossing a volume threshold 761, 762.
[00122] With reference now to FIG. 8, shown is an example of a system 800 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Event-sequencing logic 810 may manifest one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to cause a sorting module in an FPGA of a mobile device to process a data component of a wireless signal after a configuration component of the wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the sorting module 861, 862; (b) of an FPGA 870; (c) of configuration components 881 or data
components 882 of a signal; or (d) of event-sequencing logic 710. In some contexts, for example, FPGA 870 may be configured or reconfigured to implement a sorting module 875 (a bubble sort utility, e.g.) or other such utility modules as described below,
[00123] In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for configuring a field programmable gate array (FPGA) as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8341469 ("Configuration device for configuring FPGA"); U.S. Pat. No. 8327117 ("Reconfigurable FADEC with flash based FPGA control channel and ASIC sensor signal processor for aircraft engine control"); U.S. Pat. No. 8294396 ("Compact FPGA-based digital motor controller"); U.S. Pat. No. 8225081 ("Updating programmable logic devices"); U.S. Pat. No. 8205066 ("Dynamically configured coprocessor for different extended instruction set personality specific to application program with shared memory storing instructions invisibly dispatched from host processor"); U.S. Pat. No. 8205037 ("Data storage device capable of recognizing and controlling multiple types of memory chips operating at different voltages"); U.S. Pat, No. 8190699 ("System and method of multi-path data communications"); U.S. Pat. No. 8166237 ("Configurable allocation of thread queue resources in an FPGA"); U.S. Pat. No. 8095508 ("Intelligent data storage and processing using FPGA devices"); and U.S. Pat. No. 8069275 ("Network-based system for configuring a programmable hardware element in a measurement system using hardware configuration programs generated based on a user specification").
[00124] With reference now to FIG. 9, shown is an example of a system 900 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. A password generation module 986 or other configuration unit 980 (implemented in network 990, e.g.) is operably coupled to event-sequencing logic 910 via a wireless LAN or other linkage 995. Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 910 comprises one or more instances (a) of electrical nodes 921, 922, 923, 924, 925, 926, 927, 928; (b) of circuitry configured to obtain via an antenna configuration data establishing a security protocol 931, 932 ; or (c) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to indicate a wireless communication service provided within a region by a device as a response to an indication from another device of the wireless communication service being operative within the region 9 1.
[00125] With reference now to FiG. 10, shown is an example of a system 1000 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Event-sequencing logic 1010 may manifest (as a general-purpose processing core executing software or in an FPGA 870 implemented in a mobile device, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to provide a network access service responsive to whether or not access request data satisfies a security protocol 1021, 022, 1023; (b) of circuitry configured to establish both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device 1031, 1032; or (c) of application modules 1041, 1042, 1043, 1044. Alternatively or additionally, event-sequencing logic 1010 (implemented in a circuit, board 360 or ASIC 540, e.g.) may include data-handling media 1050 containing one or more instances of commands 1068 or of patterns 1071 , 072 or of protocol
implementation code 1088, 089 or other device-executable code 1085. In some variants, moreover, such logic may be operably coupled via linkage 1095 with a wide area network 1095 (comprising one or more satellites 1 93, e.g.).
[00126] With reference now to FiG. 11, shown is an example of a system 1100 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
Event-sequencing logic 1110 may manifest (as a general -purpose processing core executing software or in a mixed-signal or other FPGA 870 implemented in a mobile device, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of capture modules 1121 configured to capture audio clips; (b) of capture modules 1121 configured to capture video clips; (c) of global positioning system (GPS) modules 1122 configured to annotate wireless signals with position data; (d) of speech recognition modules; (e) of text-to-speech translation modules 1124; (f) of digital-to-analog converters 1125, 1126; (f) of decryption modules 1131, 1132 ; (g) of circuitry configured to signal a decision of how much user data to transmit via a communication channel responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the communication channel exceeds a threshold 1141, 1142; (h) of decoding modules 1151, 1152; (i) of comparators 1161, 1162; (j) of aggregation modules 1171, 1172, 1173, 1174; or (k) of transmission modules 1181, 1182, 1183, 1184. In some contexts, for example, event-sequencing logic 1110 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
[00127] With reference now to FiG. 12, shown is an example of a system 1200 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 1210 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g. ) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to receive a wireless signal containing access request data 1201, 1202 ; (b) of circuitry configured to cause a first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not a second device is within a WLA communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device 1221, 222; or (c) of microphones 1217. Alternatively or additionally, event-sequencing logic 1210 may include data-handling media 1270 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) containing a list 1250 of two or more records 1261, 262, 1263, Each such record m ay include one or more instances of avatars 1251 or other identifications 1252 (representing a person or device known to a user, e.g.); of status indications 1253, 254; or of other such data 1255 as described below. In some contexts, for example, event- sequencing logic 1210 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
[00128] With reference now to FiG. 13, shown is an example of a system 1300 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Event-sequencing logic 1310 may include various memories 431, 432 or other data-handling media 1350 containing one or more instances of data 1301, 1302, 1303, 1304; of digitally expressed times 1311, 321, 1323, 1324; of signals 1321 , 1322, 1323, 1324; of services 1331 , 1332, 1333, 1334, 1335; or of indications 1341, 1342, 1343, 1344, 1345 as described below. Alternati vely or additionally, event-sequencing logic 1310 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to implement a firewall separating two or more network access services provided via a single device 1371 or (b) of circuitry configured to obtain an indication of a wireless communication service having been provided within a service region 1372. In some variants, moreover, such logic may be operably coupled via linkage 1395 with a wireless local area network 1390 (comprising one or more servers 1396, e.g.). In some contexts, for example, event-sequencing logic 1310 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540.
[00129] With reference now to FiG. 14, showrn is an example of a system 1400 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented. User interface 1410 may include various data-handling media. 1450 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) containing one or more instances of decisions 1401, 1402, 1403, 1404, 1405; of results 1411, 1412, 1413; of digitally expressed volumes 1416; of intervals 1421, 422, 1423; of notifications 1425; or of other such expressions 1431, 1432 (comprising sequences 1435 of symbols, e.g.). In some variants, moreover, user interface 1410 may manifest (in an FPGA 870 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to obtain at, one device an identifier of another device 1481; (b) of circuitry configured to signal an availability to participate in a telephonic communication responsive to a Boolean indication of a device being within a wireless communication range of another device 1482; or (c) of circuitry configured to detect an availability to participate in a telephonic communication responsive to a Boolean indication whether or not a device exceeded a boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval 1483. In some contexts, for example, user interface 14 0 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00130] Wit reference now to FiG. 5, shown is an example of a system 1500 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Device 1530 may communicate via linkage 1531 with a vehicle 1510 (optionally implementing a mobile hotspot, e.g.) operated by user 1502 or with a handheld device 276Θ operated by user 2701 (via a WLAN or other wireless linkage 1536, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, device 1530 may (optionally) include one or more instances of FPGA 1540 configured to facilitate network management as described below. In some contexts, for example, device 1530 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00131] In light of teachings herein, moreover, numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special-purpose circuitry or other structures effective for implementing such communication (in mesh networks comprising moving nodes, e.g.) as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 831 1509 ("Detection, communication and control in multimode cellular, TDMA, GSM, spread spectrum, CDMA, OFDM WiLAN and WiFi systems"); U.S. Pat. No. 8259822 ("Polar
and quadrature modulated cellular, WiFi, WiLAN, satellite, mobile, communication and position finder systems"); U.S. Pat. No. 8249256 ("Method for providing fast secure handoff in a wireless mesh network"); U.S. Pat. N o, 8248968 ("Method and apparatus for providing mobile inter-mesh communication points in a multi-level wireless mesh network"); U.S. Pat. No. 8223694 ("Enhanced information sendees using devices in short-range wireless networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8219312 ("Determining speed parameters in a geographic area"); U.S. Pat. No. 8200243 ("Mobile television (TV), internet, cellular systems and Wi-Fi networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8184656 ("Control channel negotiated intermittent wireless communication"); U.S. Pat. No. 816931 1 ("Wireless transmission system, for vehicular component control and monitoring"); U.S. Pat. No. 8165091 ("Efficient handover of media communications in heterogeneous IP networks using LAN profiles and network handover rules"); U.S. Pat. No. 8125896 ("Individualizing a connectivity-indicative mapping"); U.S. Pat. No. 811 622 ("Signal routing dependent on a node speed change prediction"); U.S. Pat. No. 8098753 ("infrared, touch screen, W- CDMA, GSM, GPS camera phone"); U.S. Pat, No. 7646712 ("Using a signal route dependent on a node speed change prediction"); U.S. Pat. App. No. 13/31 7,988
("Context-sensitive query enrichment"); U.S. Pat. App. No. 5 5 /252,206 ("Signal routing dependent on a loading indicator of a mobile node"); U.S. Pat. App. No. 1 1 /221 ,421 ("Pleading dependent routing"); and U.S. Pat. App. No. 1 1/221 ,396 ("Pleading dependent routing method and network subsystem"),
[00132 J With reference now to FIG. 16, shown is an example of a system 1 00 (a network subsystem, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
Supervisor unit 1630 (instantiated in a vehicle 1510 or other device, e.g.) includes one or more instances of allocation modules 1641, 1642; of detection modules 1671, 1672, 1673, 1674; or of input modules 1681, 1682, 1683, 1684 as described below. In some contexts, for example, supervisor unit 1630 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00133] With reference now to FIG. 17, shown is an example of a system 1700 comprising a portable or other device 1750 in a communication network 1790 (an ad hoc or mesh network, e.g.) in which one or more technologies may be implemented.
Numerous other devices 1752, 1754, 1756, 1758, 1760, 1762, 1764, 1766, 1768, 1770,
1772, 1774, 1776, 1778, 1780, 1782, 1784, 1786 (each comprising a cell tower or handheld device or vehicle or other portable device, e.g.) are linked via various passive- media linkages 1771 (through air or cables, e.g.). In various implementations, device 1750 may (optionally) include one or more instances of interface modules 1721, 1722, 1723, 1724, 1725, 1726; of response modules 1731, 1732, 1733, 1734, 1735, 1736, 1737, 1738, 739; or of notification modules 1741, 1742, 743, 1744, 1745, 746 described below. Alternatively or additionally, one or more devices 1754, 786 (implemented as supervisor units having access to one or more databases defining service characteristics pertaining to a local jurisdiction, e.g. ) may be configured to send configuration data (extracted or otherwise derived from such databases, e.g.) manifesting wireless channel attributes (implementing power and frequency limitations relating to regulatory specifications, e.g.) to other devices in network 1790, effectively specifying how they are to reconfigure themselves. See FIGS. 18-23, Such adjustments can be used for congestion relief (during peak usage times, e.g.), for example, or for other resource management as described herein, in some contexts, for example, such devices 1750 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00134] With reference now to FIG. 18, shown is an example of a system 1800 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Event-sequencing logic 1810
(implemented in a circuit board 360 or AS IC 54Θ, e.g.) may include one or more instances of FPGAs 1820 or of configuration components 1841 and data components 1842 of signals. In some contexts, for example, an FPGA 1 20 may be configured or reconfigured to include a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module 1823 or other event- sequencing stractures as described below. Moreover some variants of event-sequencing logic 1810 may locally manifest one or more instances of circuitry configured to cause an FFT module in an FPGA of a mobile device to process a data component of a wireless signal after a configuration component of another wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module 1881, 1882.
[00135] With reference now to FIG. 19, shown is an example of a system 1900 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Device 1910 (instantiated in one or more devices 1754, 1764 of network 1790, e.g. ) may include one or more instances of key press events 1931, 1932 or other such user input 1940 (manifested digitally, e.g.); of
interpersonal commu ications 1961, 1962, 1963 (calls 19S1 or sessions 1952 or dialogs 1953, e.g.); of registration modules 1971, 1972, 1973, 1974; or of aggregation modules 1981, 1982, Such devices 1910 may be operably coupled via a wireless or other linkage 1995 with telephone network 1990 (comprising one or more telephone switches 1996, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such devices 1910 may comprise one or more antennas 1905 (parabolic or shortwave or whip or Yagi-Uda or metamaterial antennas, for example, instantiated in FIG, 17 mechanically coupled with most or all of devices 1750, 1752, 1754, 1756, 1758, 1760, 1762, 1764, 1766, 1768, 1770, 1772, 1774, 1776, 1778, 1780, 1782, 784, 1786). In some contexts, for example, device 1910 may include a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00136] With reference now to FIG, 20, shown is an example of a system 2000 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. One or more media 2110 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) may contain one or more instances of digitally expressed fractions 2011, 2012; of configuration data 2015; of coordinates 2021, 2022; of passwords 2035, 2036 or other access codes 2031 , 2032; of signals 2051, 2052, 2053, 2054, 2Θ55, 2056, 2057, 2058, 2059; of indications 2071, 2072, 2073, 2074, 2Θ75, 2076, 2077, 2078, 2079; of thresholds 2081, 2082, 2083, 2Θ84, 2085, 2086, 2087, 2088, 2Θ89; of clips 2090 (of video or audio data, e.g.); or of rates 2091 , 2092, 2Θ93, 2094, 2095, 2096.
[00137] With reference now to FIG. 21, shown is an example of a system 2100 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. One or more memories or other media 2110 may contain one or more instances of indicators 2102, 2103; of series 2125 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 of auditory data 2120 (primarily having been obtained via a microphone, e.g.); or of series 2135 of data blocks 2131, 2132, 2133 of encrypted data 2130. Other user data 2150 of interest for present purposes may (optionally) include other encrypted data 2130, video or other image data; or computational modeling data (pertaining to meteorology or research, e.g.).
[00138] With reference now to FIG. 22, shown is an example of a system 2200 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. One or more memories or other media 2210 (of storage or guided transmission or display, e.g.) may comprise one or more instances of informational models 2301; of images 2251; of decisions 2221, 2222, 2223,
2224, 2225, 2226, 2227, 2228; of indications 2271, 2272, 2273, 2274, 2275, 2276, 2277, 2278, 2279; of services 2281, 2282, 2283, 2284; of phone numbers 2285 or other such identifiers 2286; of percentages 2291, 2292, 2293; of hardware description language (HDL or VHDL, e.g.) expressions 2296, 2297; or of counts 2298, 2299. Image 2251, for example, depicts virtual regions 2255, 2265 relating to actual regions 155, 165 as generally described below (with reference to FIG, 1, e.g.).
[00139] With reference now to FIG, 23, shown is an example of a system 2300 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. One or more memories or other media 2310 may comprise one or more instances of informational models 2301; of status data 2320; of maps 2330 or segments 2337 thereof; or of versions 2361, 2362, 2363 (of an image or other expression of model 2301, e.g.). In some contexts, for example, such status data may (optionally) include one or more records 2327, 2328, 2329 each comprising one or more expressions (1 ) of times 2311, (2) of positions 2312, or (3) of shape-descriptive information 2313 relating to one or more wireless service regions or devices. Several non-overlapping zones 2351, 2352, 2353, 2354, 2355, 2356 are shown. Some zones 2351 , 2354, 2355 together form a circular region centered at position 2341, containing several identified positions 2347, 2348, 2349, and having a radius 2345 representing a real-world radius on the order (within an order of magnitude) of ten meters or of one kilometer. Another version 2362 depicts position 2349 outside a region (comprising zones 2352, 2354) of service 1331. Another version 2363 depicts position 2349 within a region (comprising zones 2351 , 2352, 2354, 2355) of service 1331 but not within an overlapping region (comprising zones 2353, 2355) of service 1332. Such versions depict various states (including Wi-Fi service outages, e.g.), modes of model updates, or cost- indicative depictions of such services as generally described below (with reference to FIG. 31, e.g.).
[00140] With reference now to FIG. 24, shown is an example of a system 2400 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Event-sequencing logic 2410 may bear (as a digital expression, e.g.) one or more instances of decryption code 2425 or signals 2430. In a context in which event-sequencing logic 2410 includes one or more digital or analog speedometers 2420 (instantiated in one or more vehicles 1510 or other mobile devices 160, 2760, e.g.), for example, such signals may comprise data indicating a
ground speed or a geographic position (of GPS module 1122 or other event-sequencing logic 1110, 2410, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such signals may include one or more instances of control parameters 2431 or of data segments 2432, 2433, 2434 (user data, e.g.). In some variants, moreover, event-sequencing logic 2410 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1772 of network 1790, e.g.) may manifest (in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal 2471 , 2472 or (b) of circuitry configured to cause first content of a wireless signal to pass through a first memory of an integrated circuit if second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion and otherwise to cause the first content to pass through a second memory of the integrated circuit 2481, 2482. In some contexts, for example, event-sequencing logic 2410 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00141 | With reference now to FIG. 25, shown is an example of a system 2500 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Contiguous or other event-sequencing logic 2510 (instantiated in one or more devices 1758, 1768, 1778 of network 1790, e.g.) may include (in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a general-purpose processing core executing software, e.g.) one or more instances (a) of circuitry configured to detect a series of service region departure events 2501; (b) of circuitry configured to implement a specific positional model that represents both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator 2502; (c) of circuitry configured to decrease a dataflow through a wireless communication channel incrementally 2503; (d) of circuitry remote from a user configured to signal a result via a device local to the user 2504; (e) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel 2505; (f of circuitry configured to transmit user data via an ad hoc network 2506; (g) of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data 2507; (h) of circuitry configured to map a cost-indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication 2508; or (i) of circuitry configured to compare a data block delivery failure rate against a threshold 2509. In
some contexts, for example, event-sequencing logic 2510 may be implemented in a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above,
[00142] With reference now to FiG. 26, shown is an example of a system 2600 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Detection unit 2610 may (optionally) include one or more instances of processing modules 2641, 2642, 2643, 2644; of configuration modules 2671, 2672, 2673, 2674, 2675, 2676, 2677, 2678; or of a charging sensor 2607 configured to indicate a charging state 26 7 (as a Boolean or digital scalar expression, e.g.) of a battery 2615. In some variants, moreover, detection unit 2610 may manifest (on a circuit board 360 or as software executed by a processing core, e.g.) one or more instances of circuitry configured to signal a decision whether or not to cause a configurable core to draw from a first data queue in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2681 or of circuitry configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2682, n some contexts, for example, detection unit 2610 may be implemented in or operably coupled with a circuit board 360 or ASIC 540 as described above.
[00143] With reference now to FiG. 27, shown is an example of a system 2700 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. At least two parallel communication channels 2770, 2780 are established between endpoint devices 2750, 2760 so that an interpersonal communication can occur between device users 15Θ1, 2701. This permits a signal 2757, for example, to travel via linkage 2767 and via one or more intermediate devices 2771, 2772 comprising channel 2770. Likewise a signal 2758 can travel via linkage 2768 and via one or more intermediate devices 2781, 2782 comprising channel 2780. In some variants, moreover, ASIC 540 may be configured either (a) so that channel 2770 includes queue 570 and so that channel 2780 includes queue 580 or (b) so that two or more channels 2770, 2780 are simultaneously processed each through a respective integrated circuit (instances of gate arrays or other IC's 365, 366 mounted on circuit board 360, e.g.).
[00144] With reference now to FiG. 32, shown is a high-level logic flow 3200 of an operational process. Operation 28 describes establishing both a wireless communication
channel via a. first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device (e.g. initiation modules 171, 172 respectively creating parallel communication channels 2770, 2780 from device 2760, each including at least one wireless linkage 2767, 2768). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2771 (instantiated in one or more devices 1772, 1774 of network 1790, e.g.) is the "first" device; in which device 2760 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 756, 1774 of network 1790, e.g.) is the "second" device; in which device 2782 is the "third" device; in which channel 2770 comprises one or more devices 2771, 2772 via which signals 2057, 2757 can travel (to and from device 2760, e.g.); in which channel 2780 comprises one or more devices 2781, 2782 via which signals 2058, 2758 can likewise travel in both directions; and in which such channels 2770, 2780 exist simultaneously. In a telephonic implementation, for example, such channels 2770, 2780 may both bear digitized auditory data 2120 simultaneously, optionally including a particular component of user data 2150 (block 2123, e.g.) passing simultaneously through a primary channel 2770 (as signal 2757, e.g.) and redundantly through another channel 2780 (as signal 2758, e.g.).
[00145| In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for establishing or characterizing a communication channel as described herein without undue
experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8234523 ("Automatic determination of success of using a computerized decision support system"); U.S. Pat. No. 8233471 ("Wireless network system and method for providing same"); U.S. Pat. No. 8145975 ("Universal packet loss recovery system for delivery of real-time streaming multimedia content over packet-switched networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8054856 ("Method for synchronizing voice traffic with minimum latency in a communications network"); U.S. Pat. No. 7835314 ("Physical layer interface system and method for a wireless communication system"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7787896 ("Dispatch service architecture framework").
[00146] Operation 32 describes signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a. data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure
rate threshold (e.g. allocation module 1641 causing one or more transmission modules 1181, 1182 to increase a fraction 2012 of digitized auditory data 2120 transmitted via channel 2780 as an incremental response to an indication 2076 that a data block delivery failure rate 2091 of channel 2770 exceeds a threshold 2081), This can occur, for example, in a context in which the incremental response causes a. partial reduction in a volume of data block delivery failure events; in which data block delivery failure rate 2091 describes a percentage 2291 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 transmitted via linkage 2767 that do not pass via an antenna of device 2771 or that do not reach device 2750 within a permissible latency threshold 2082; in which a volatile memory 262 of supervisor unit 1630 (instantiated in one or more devices 1766, 1772 of network 1790, e.g.) implements several media 2010, 2110, 2210 as described above; and in which such wireless communication channel allocations would otherwise be made in a crude or unduly computation-intensive fashion (by conventional signal strength or load balancing or bit error rate indicia, e.g. ). In some contexts, for example, a latency threshold 2082 for digitized voice data communication routing may be less than 0.5 seconds and the effective threshold 2081 applied to data block delivery failure rate 2091 may be less than 5%. Alternatively or additionally, one or both such thresholds 2081 , 2082 may effectively depend upon an indication 2Θ75 of one or more attributes of channel 2780 (a data block delivery failure rate 2092 of linkage 2768, e.g.) or other such determinants as described herein. In some contexts, for example, allocation module 1641 may be configured to close channel 2780 when a traffic volume through channel 2780 becomes low enough (after several iterations of operation 32, e.g.).
[00147| In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for implementing a timing or other comparison as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8325901 ("Methods and apparatus for providing expanded
telecommunications service"); U.S. Pat. No. 8321727 ("System and method responsive to a rate of change of a performance parameter of a memory"); U.S. Pat. No. 8320261 ("Method and apparatus for troubleshooting subscriber issues on a telecommunications network"); U.S. Pat. No. 8315(522 ("Motion adaptive communications device and integrated circuits for use therewith"); U.S. Pat. No. 831 1579 ("Multi-mode mobile
coniinunication device with motion sensor and methods for use therewith"); U.S. Pat. No. 8295395 ("Methods and apparatus for partial interference reduction within wireless networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8290509 ("Deactivation system and method for a transferable device"): U.S. Pat. No. 8264953 ("Resilient data communications with physical layer link aggregation, extended failure detection and load balancing"); U.S. Pat. No. 8224349 ("Timed fingerprint locating in wireless networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8195478 ("Network performance monitor"); U.S. Pat. No. 8184580 ("Data packet, communication scheduling in a commumcation system"); U.S. Pat. No. 7881992 ("Methods and systems for processing and managing corporate action information"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7853268 ("GPS enabled cell phone location tracking for security purposes").
[00148] With reference now to FIG, 28, shown is an example of a system 2800 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. A computer 2810 in an office 2820 includes a display 2815, a microphone 2817, a keyboard, a speaker, and a mouse. An identifier (phone number 2285, e.g.) of a remote mobile device 2870 or its user 2880 are available (listed, e.g. ) at computer 281 . When mobile device 2870 is within a wireless local area network (WLAN) communication range 2866 of one or more WLAN routers 2860 (instantiated in one or more devices 1768, 1784 of network 1700, e.g.), an interpersonal communication (a video chat via displays 2815, 2875 or telephone call, e.g.) can occur via computer 2810 and mobile device 2870 and via linkages 2895, 2896 with network 2890 as shown. In some contexts, moreover, status information concerning mobile device 287Θ is available at computer 2810 even before such communication is initiated.
[001491 With reference now to FIG. 33, shown is a high-level logic flow 3300 of an operational process. Operation 24 describes obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device (e.g. registration module 1971 maintaining a local instance of contact list 1250 within computer 2810 including a phone number 2285 or similar identification 1252 associated with user 2880). This can occur, for example, in a context in which computer 2810 is the "first" device (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1752 of network 1790, e.g.); in which mobile device 2870 is the "second" device; and in which a telephone switch 1996 or server 1396 associates phone number 2285 with one or more
mobile devices 2870 owned by user 2880 (instantiated in one or more devices 1768, 1782, 1786 of network 1790, e.g.).
[00150] Operation 30 describes causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device (e.g. notification module 1744 triggering computer 2810 to display a positive status indication 1254 signifying that mobile device 2870 is within a wireless IAN communication range 2866 without first establishing a telephone call 1951 or similar bidirectional interpersonal communication 1961 between computer 2810 and mobile device 2870). This can occur, for example, in a context in which wireless LAN communication range 2866 is established as an operating range of one or more WLAN devices (wireless LAN router 2860, e.g.): in which display 2815 presents such an indication 1254 in conjunction with other information about, user 2880 (in record 1261, e.g.); in which a user 101 of computer 2810 can initiate a telephone call 1951 or similar interpersonal communication 1961 to user 2880 via computer 2810 in response to one or more such indications 1253, 254; in which such telephone calls 1951 are cost effective (free of charge to user 2880, e.g.) and in which user 2880 would otherwise be unable or displeased to participate in such communication (incurring a significant roaming charge, e.g.).
[00151] In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for signaling an availability or other status as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8306005 ("Dynamic communication and method of use"); U.S. Pat. No. 8289210 ("Location measurement acquisition adaptive optimization"); U.S. Pat. No. 8271626 ("Methods for displaying physical network topology and environmental status by location, organization, or responsible party"); U.S. Pat. No. 8260896 ("Monitoring business machines using a mesh network on field nodes"); U.S. Pat. No. 8249616 ("Satellite (GPS) assisted clock apparatus, circuits, systems and processes for cellular terminals on asynchronous networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8208489 ("Method for reporting downstream packet resequencing status in cable modem"); U.S. Pat. No. 8195198 ("System, method and apparatus for protecting privacy when a mobile device is located
in a defined privacy zone"): U.S. Pat. No. 8108501 ("Searching and route mapping based on a social network, location, and time"); U.S. Pat. No. 8059788 ("Telephone software testing system and method"); U.S. Pat. No. 805901 1 ("Outage notification system"); U.S. Pat. No. 8037126 ("Systems and methods of dynamically checking freshness of cached objects based on link status"); U.S. Pat. No. 8010230 ("Robotic ordering and delivery apparatuses, systems and methods"); U.S. Pat. No. 800591 1 ("Systems for
communicating current location information among mobile internet users and methods therefor"); U.S. Pat. No. 7860648 ("Map display system, and method"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7392017 ("Assessing wireless network quality").
[00152] With reference now to FIG. 29, shown is an example of a system 2900 in which one or more technologies may be implemented . A mobile device 2910 (a
communication-enabled vehicle 1510 or handheld device, e.g.) meanders along a path 2901 through a series of positions 2903, 2904, 2905, 2906, 2907, 2908, 2909 at each of which there is an apparent wirel ess service boundary 2961, 2971, 2981. Even if the devices that provide the wireless service zones 2960, 2970, 2980 in a region 2955 are unknown or unavailable or transient (by hot spot movements or intermittencies, e.g.), a rate at which some such crossings occur constitutes a useful availability determinant as described belo w.
[001531 With reference now to FIG. 34, shown is a high-level logic flow 3400 of an operational process. Operation 27 describes obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first device exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour (e.g. detection module 1671 generating a comparison result 1411 as a direct or indirect Boolean indication 2271 that a maximum crossing rate threshold 2084 was greater than an average rate 2094 at which device 2910 had apparently crossed wireless service zone boundaries 2961, 2971, 2981 in a region 2955 during a particular time interval 1421). This can occur, for example, in a context in which aggregation module 1171 has received a series of several indications 2071, 2072, 2073, 2074 of crossing events; in which one or more of such indications 2071 was not "qualifying" (because it did not pertain to an event within time interval 1421, e.g.); in which time interval 1421 is on the order of a second or of a minute; and in which detection module 1671 (comprising comparator 1161, e.g.)
compares a count 2299 of such other indications 2072, 2073, 2074 with threshold 2084. In an implementation of detection module 1671 in which threshold 2084 is four, for example, a count 2299 of three crossings (e.g. at positions 2904, 2905, 2906) will result in a negative indication 2271 (signifying infrequent crossings, e.g.). In another context (in which only service region departures are "qualifying," e.g.) detection module 1671 may generate a positive indication 2271 (signifying frequent crossings, e.g.) by applying a nominal threshold 2084 of two against a count 2299 of three (signifying registration module 1974 detecting departure events at position 2905 from zone 2970 and at position 2908 from zone 2980 and at, position 2909 from zone 2970, e.g.). Other variants of detection module 1671 may perform, operation 27 using a variety of protocols. A.
crossing rate threshold 2084 may be effectively adapted by applying one or more offsets or multipliers to count 2299, for example, or by including other quantitative modifiers as described herein. Alternatively or additionally, detection module 1671 may implement conjunctive determinants (a Boolean value 744 configured to enable indication 2271 conditionally, e.g.); disjunctive determinants (a Boolean value 745 configured to override indication 2271 conditionally, e.g.); or other such modes of implementing comparisons as indicated herein.
[00154] Operation 33 describes signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device (e.g.
notification module 1743 causing a headset or display 2875 to provide a user 1502, 2880 with an automatic and conditional decision 1404 as to whether or not device 2910 is currently available to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication 1962). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2910 is the "first" device; in which device 160 is the "second" device; in which wireless service zone 2960 comprises a wireless communication range of device 160; in which decision 1404 will be positive (signaling availability, e.g.) if device 2910 remains continuously within wireless service zone 2960 for longer than time interval 1421; in which time interval 1421 is on the order of a second or of a minute; and in which much more resource-intensive modeling
(requiring frequent monitoring of satellite 1093 by GPS module 1122, e.g.) would otherwise be required to determine whether the first device is currently viable for such a communication. In some variants, moreover, determining availability by another mode (purely by a ground speed of device 2910 being low enough, e.g.) might generate false negatives unduly (failing to recognize viable ongoing availability in a context of tra veling within region 165 and alongside device 160 for an extended period, e.g.). Decisio 1404 may (optionally) be signaled by a sound (a chord, e.g.) or by a word ("ready," e.g.) or other displayed symbol (a light-emitting diode coming on, e.g.), for example, or by other such expressions 1431 played or displayed at user interface 1410 (instantiated in one or more devices 1756, 1758 of network 1700, e.g.). In some embodiments notification module 1743 may signal a positive decision 1404 by establishing the bidirectional interpersonal communication 1962 (comprising a video chat session 1952 or similar dialog 1953, e.g.), moreover, or may signal a negative decision 1404 by doing nothing.
[00155] With reference now to FIG. 30, shown is an example of a system 3000 in which one or more technologies may be implemented. Two networks 3080, 3090 are each operably coupled with a communications tower 3085 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 770 of network 1700, e.g.) and with a network access control (NAC) unit 3030 (implementing a wireless router, e.g.) comprising several control modules 3031, 3032, 3033, 3034. One such control module 3031 interacts with device 2750 and conditionally provides a first network access service (to network 3080, e.g.). One or more other devices (computer 3060, e.g.) are likewise conditionally provided (by one or more other corresponding control modules 3034, e.g.) with network access service(s) as described below.
[00156] With reference now to FIG. 35, shown is a high-level logic flow 3500 of an operational process. Operation 26 describes obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol (e.g. input module 1684 receiving via one or more linkages 295, 995 a secure access code 2031 effectively deeming one or more data patterns 1071 to be "acceptable"). This can occur, for example, in a context in which secondary device 220 includes data storage medium 2010 (non-volatile memory 271, e.g.); in which such linkages include a signal-bearing conduit (an antenna 205, 1905 or optical cable, e.g.) as the "first" device, via which configuration unit 980 transmits access
code 2031 to supervisor unit 1630; and in which access code 2031 includes a current password 2035 provided by password generation module 986. In some contexts, for example, a secondary device 220 remote from supervisor unit 1630 may be configured to perform such transmissions regularly (daily, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, one or more instances of configuration unit 980 may implement an initial security-protocol- implementing data pattern 1071 (during manufacture of supervisor unit 1630, e.g.) for limiting access to one or more services 2281, 2282 (network resources, e.g.) prior to any reconfiguration of supervisor unit, 1630.
[00157] Operation 29 describes obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data (e.g. interface module 1721 receiving a wireless signal 1323 containing access request, data 1301). This can occur, for example, in a context in which primary device 210 includes event-sequencing logic 1010, 310 (instantiated in one or more devices 1782, 784 of network 1700, e.g. ); in which the "second" device is an antenna 1905 operably coupled to device 2750 or to NAC unit 3030 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1768, 774 of network 1790, e.g.); and in which device 2750 transmits wireless signal 1323 as a response to input 1940 (key press events 1931 , 1932 or voice commands 1068, e.g.) from user 2701 (initiating a telephone call 1951, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, device 2750 may transmit access request data 1301
(requesting to establish an open channel 2770, e.g.) as an automatic response to device 2750 entering a zone 2970 (comprising a wireless operating range of device 2772, e.g.).
[001581 Operation 31 describes signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol (e.g. registration module 1972 signaling a decision 1401 to provide device 2750 with a service 1333 that includes access to network 3080 via control module 3031 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1041 determining that access request data 1301 matches security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1071).
[00159] In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for providing a limited access service as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 831 1035 ("Methods and apparatus for communicating internet protocol based control
signaling through a communications system"); U.S. Pat. No. 8306518 ("Handset service migration automation and subscriber identity module tracking"); U.S. Pat, No. 830(5005 ("Dynamic communication and method of use"): U.S. Pat. No. 8300575 ("Priority bearers in a mobile telecommunication network"): U.S. Pat. No. 8290551 ("Systems and methods for efficiently positioning a directional antenna module to receive and transmit the most effective band width of wireless transmissions"); U.S. Pat. No. 8279838
("Mobility mechanisms for home cellular network"); U.S. Pat. No. 8223752 ("Method for accessing service resource items that are for use in a telecommunications system"); U.S. Pat. No. 8204966 ("Map tile data pre-fetching based on user activity analysis"); U.S. Pat. No. 81 85122 ("Method for creating a cellular telephone infrastructure"); U.S. Pat. No. 8161542 ("Wireless perimeter security device and network using same"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7957418 ("Data burst communication techniques for use in increasing data throughput to mobile communication devices").
[00160] Operation 35 describes signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service (e.g. allocation module 1642 signaling a conditional decision 1402 not to provide an entity that transmits access request data 1301 with a service 1334 that includes access to network 3090 as an automatic and conditional response to application module 1042 determining that access request data 1301 does not match security-protocol-implementing data pattern 1072). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2750 is the "second" device; in which IN AC unit 3030 is the "third" device; in which control module 3031 provides the "second" device with access to network 3080 (as the "first" network access service, e.g.); in which control module 3034 would simultaneously provide a "fourth" device (computer 3060, e.g.) with access to network 3090 (as the "second" network access service, e.g.) if the "fourth" device had transmitted access request data 1302 matching data pattern 1072; in which NAC unit implements event-sequencing logic 810, 1810 (instantiated in one or more devices 1774, 1784 of network 1790, e.g. ) and media 1350, 1450; and in which the "first" network access service would otherwise need to be provided by a "fifth" device (tower 3085, e.g.). In some contexts, for example, control
module 3032 may implement the firewall between the "first" and "second" network access services (access to networks 3080, 3090 respectively, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, control module 3033 may be remotely configurable (implemented in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or non-volatile memory 243, e.g.) to permit an adjustment of the location of the firewall or otherwise control an allocation of resources i AC unit 3030.
[00161] With reference now to FIG. 31, shown is an example of a system 3100 in which one or more technologies may be implemented . At an earlier time, router 3101 provided WLAN or other wireless service to any devices 3180 (communication-enabled vehicles 1510 or handheld devices, e.g.) that were within zone 3121, Other routers 3102, 3103 in the region 3155 provide ongoing wireless service within respective disjoint zones 3122, 3123 as shown, and both continue to communicate with network 3190, Another device 3160 obtains wireless service status versions 3162, 3163 (indicating service availability within zone 3121, e.g.) with corresponding timing data 3165 as described below.
[00162] In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for implementing a firewall as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8327431 ("Managing configurations of a firewall"); U.S. Pat. No. 8316435 ("Routing device having integrated MPLS-aware firewall with virtual security system support"); U.S. Pat, No. 8300532 ("Forwarding plane configuration for separation of services and forwarding in an integrated services router"); U.S. Pat, No. 8230516 ("Apparatus, system, and method for network authentication and content distribution"); U.S. Pat. No. 8209400 ("System for data routing in networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8121648 ("Adaptive beamforming configuration methods and apparatus for wireless access points serving as handoff indication mechanisms in wireless local area networks"); U.S. Pat. No. 8065357 ("Output management system and method for enabling access to private network resources"); U.S. Pat. No. 8059650 ("Hardware based parallel processing cores with multiple threads and multiple pipeline stages"); U.S. Pat. No. 8024482 ("Dynamic firewall configuration"); U.S. Pat. No. 8018856 ("Director device with visual display arrangement and methods thereof ); U.S. Pat. No. 8004971 ("Method and system for scaling network traffic managers using connection keys"): U.S. Pat. No. 7924927
("Distributed functionality in a wireless communications network"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7804954 ("Infrastructure for enabling high quality real-time audio"),
[00163] With reference now to FIG. 3 , shown is a high-level logic flow 3600 of an operational process. Operation 25 describes obtaining an indication of a first wireless communication service having been provided within a first service region by a first device at an earlier time (e.g. aggregation module 1981 receiving a notification 1425 that mobile device 3180 was at coordinates 2021, 2022 three weeks ago at which time a wireless service 2283 had been established between device 3180 and network 3190 via router 3101). This can occur, for example, in a context in which FIG. 31 generally depicts the "earlier" time; in which the "first" service region comprises either zone 3121 or a subset of it that excludes zone 3122; in which router 3101 is the "first" device (instantiated in one or more devices 1768, 1770 of network 1790, e.g.); in which notification 1425 arrived at, aggregation module 1981 almost three weeks ago; in which aggregation module 1981 maintains status data 2320 about the availability of wireless services within a region 3155 depicted by map 2330; and in which status data 2320 includes an estimated position 2341 of router 3101 (determined by a detection module 1672 using GPS or other tri angulation protocols, e.g.) at the earlier time 1311 (three weeks ago, e.g.). In some contexts, for example, timing data 3165 (derived from a signal 1322 from an instance of device 3180 traveling across zones 3121-3123 and maintained in status data 2320, e.g.) may indicate that as of three weeks ago, service 1331 was operative in zones 3121, 3122 and service 1332 was operative in zone 3123,
Alternatively or additionally, status data 2320 may (optionally) include indications 2278, 2279 of "latest" wireless service status in several zones 2351-2355 near the most-recent estimated position 2341 of router 3101.
[00164| In light of teachings herein numerous existing techniques may be applied for configuring special purpose circuitry or other structures effective for characterizing a position as described herein without undue experimentation. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 8301 159 ("Displaying network objects in mobile devices based on geolocation"); U.S. Pat. No. 8295853 ("Method and system for refining accuracy of location positioning"); U.S. Pat, No. 82(59618 ("Method and system for remotely monitoring the location of a vehicle"); U.S. Pat, No. 81 (55(500 ("System and method for advertising to a Wi-Fi
device"); U.S. Pat. No. 8155077 ("Active mode internet protocol gateway relocation in a partial meshed deployment"); U.S. Pat. No. 8108145 ("Downloading map segmeiit(s) to a cell phone based upon its GPS coordinates and mobility"); and U.S. Pat. No. 7916071 ("System and method for determining a reference location of a mobile device").
[00165] Operation 34 describes signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first sen'ice region or not at a later time (e.g. response module 185 communicating to user 101 a decision 1403 that is responsive to a recent indication 2275 from device 2870 about, one or more wireless services 1331 being operative or inoperative within zone 3121). This can occur, for example, in a context in which mobile device 2870 is the "second" device and has transmitted a signal 1323 at the "later" time 1313 (yesterday, e.g.) from within zones 3121, 3122 (corresponding roughly to map position 2347, e.g. ) of which some is maintained (in status data 2320, e.g.); in which the decision 1403 is "negative" if it results in device 2760 displaying status version 3162 (indicating that service 1331 is unavailable within part of zone 3121, e.g.); in which the decision 1403 is "positive" (manifested as an instance of a voltage level 313 above a voltage threshold 2085, e.g.) if it results in device 2760 displaying status version 3 3 (indicating that service 1331 is available throughout zone 3121, e.g.); and in which user 101 would otherwise have to traverse the first service region personally to discover whether or not service 1331 is still available there. In some contexts, for example, such a decision 1403 will dictate whether device 2760 will display image version 2362 (negatively indicative of service 1331 at position 2349, e.g.) or image version 2363 (positively indicative of service 1331 at position 2349, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such signals from various devices 160, 2760, 2870, 3180 traversing region 3155 may be used (1) by a response module 181 configured to determine an indication 1341 of an approximate range of each router 3101- 3103; (2) by a response module 182 configured to determine an indication 1342 of what times of the day or week one of the routers 3102 goes offline; (3) by a response module 183 configured to determine a Boolean indication 2273 whether or not one of the routers 3101 appears to be stationary; (4) by a response module 184 configured to determine a
Boolean indication 2272 of whether or not one of the routers 3103 (instantiated in one or more devices 1784, 1786 of network 1700, e.g.) is substantially isotropic; (5) by a response module 186 configured to display via a map 2330 of a user interface 1410 a cost-indicative service boundary relating to a prospective interpersonal communication 1963 via. the user interface 1410; or (6) to perform such functions upon other devices described herein.
[00166] With reference now to flow 3700 of FIG. 37 and to other flows described above, in some variants, one or more of operations 3754, 3755, 3757, 3758 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or othenvise in conjunction with any of operations 24-35 described above.
[00167] Operation 3754 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device (e.g. response module 1735 routing some or all of wireless signal 1324 to a special- purpose video data processing module 2642 unless and until an indication 1343 is received that temperature sensor 6Θ8 exceeds a threshold). This can occur, for example, in a context in which a handheld device 2760 implements control logic 610 and other event-sequencing logic 1110, 1350; in which comparator 1162 is configured to determine whether a temperature-indicative signal 2051 therefrom exceeds threshold 2083 and to transmit a Boolean result 1413 of the comparison to response module 1735; in which threshold 2083 is calibrated so that the effective temperature threshold is 47°C; and in which an extended use of processing module 2642 would othenvise make it
uncomfortable for user 1501 to hold device 2760. In some contexts, for example, device 2760 may implement device 1750. Alternatively or additionally, an instance of application module 1043 may be implemented in a server 1396 remote from handheld device 2760 and configured to perform operation 3754 remotely (by controlling how much data 1303, 1304 to include in a wireless signal 1324 as a function of the state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 residing in handheld device 2760, e.g.). By postponing or refraining from transmitting some of the data 1304, for example, such an application module 1043 can effectively cause handheld device 2760 to cool down remotely (by deactivating or slowing operations in one or more processing modules 2641, 2642 aboard
handheld device 2760, e.g.) without wasting transmission bandwidth. In another variant, moreover, operation 3754 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 671 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 3S2 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special -purpose module in a handheld device 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 in the handheld device 2760,
[00168] Operation 3755 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device (e.g. response module 1736 causing one or more segments 2432-2434 of a wireless signal 2430 to be handled by a special-purpose processing module 2644 in a portable detection unit, 2610 as an automatic and conditional response to a sufficient charging state 2617 of a battery 2615). This can occur, for example, in a context in which detection unit 2610 comprises a portable device 1750; in which at least some segments 2434 include coordinates 2021, 2022 in a virtual reality space (game data, e.g.); in which processing module 2644 comprises an FFT module 1823 or other such special-purpose components implemented in FPG A 1820; and in which real-time rendering in response to coordinates 2021, 2022 or other such processing-intensive functions would not otherwise be feasible in a production-grade portable device 1750. In another variant, moreover, operation 3755 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2682 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module 425 in a portable secondary device 220 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1758 of network 1700, e.g.) as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery 2615. This can occur, for example, in a context in which special-purpose module 425 comprises an FFT module 592, sorting module 595, or detection module 599 formed directly on integrated circuit 440 (implementing ASIC 540, e.g.).
[00169] Operation 3757 describes causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a. mobile device as an automatic and
conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal (e.g. interface module 1724 directing one or more data segments 2431-2433 of a wireless signal 2430 from device 1774 to be processed by a special-purpose decryption moduie 1131 within device 1750 as a conditional response to a control parameter 2431 in the wireless signal 2430 being "10"). This can occur, for example, in a context in which interface module 1724 would direct data segments 2432, 2433 to be decrypted conventionally (by a general purpose central processing unit 212 executing decryption code 2425 resident in internal cache 215, e.g.) in response to control parameter 2431 being "00" or "01" or "1 1 "; and in which the algorithm embodied in such decryption code 2425 would be more readily susceptible to reverse engineering (decompilation, e.g.) than special-purpose decryption module 1131. In some contexts, for example, such a data segment 2432 may (optionally) include telephonic or other encrypted audio data blocks 2131-2133. Alternatively or additionally, in some embodiments, an initiation module 174 in device 1774 may perform operation 3757 by configuring control parameter 2431 to have a value ("10" or "1 1 ," e.g.) that causes interface module 1723 to route unencrypted data blocks 2121 -2123 to a special-purpose digital-to-analog converter 1125. This can occur, for example, in a context in which interface module 1723 would direct data segments 2432, 2433 to be converted conventionally (by DAC 1126, e.g.) in response to control parameter 2431 being "00" or "01 ". Alternatively or additionally, in some embodiments, a response module 1737 may be configured to perform an instance of operation 3757 by enabling one or more other response modules 1735, 1736 conditionally, based upon a control parameter 2431 in a received wireless signal 2430. In another variant, moreover, operation 3757 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2471 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data segment 2434 of a wireless signal 2430 to be processed by a special- purpose module (FFT moduie 592 or sorting moduie 595 or other detection module 599, e.g.) in a mobile device 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to a control parameter 2431 (access code 2032, e.g.) of the wireless signal 2430.
[001701 Operation 3758 describes causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or through a second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not
second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion (e.g. interface module 1722 routing data blocks in a wireless signal 1321 to pass through queue S70 if they comprise auditory data 2120 and otherwise generally to pass through queue 580). This can occur, for example, in a context in which wireless signal 1321 also includes a Boolean indication 2102 of whether or not the data, blocks comprise auditory data 2120, in which queue 570 resides in cache 255 or other volatile memory 262, in which queue 580 resides in phase change memory 231 or other non-volatile memory 242; and in which primary device 210 (instantiated in one or more devices 1752, 754 of network 1700, e.g.) would otherwise need either to provide an ongoing bias current to volatile memory 262 or to incur performance degradation (resulting from excessive interaction with non-volatile memory 242, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, interface module 1722 may be configured to route the data blocks in wireless signal 1321 to pass through queue 570 conditionally in response to a "positive" Boolean indication 2103 (signifying that they comprise encrypted data 2130, e.g.). In another variant, moreover, operation 3758 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2481 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a data component 881 of a wireless signal 2430 to pass through a less-accessible non-volatile memory 243 of an integrated circuit (primary device 210, e.g.) if a configuration component 882 of wireless signal 2430 satisfies a 1 st criterion and otherwise to cause the data component 881 to pass through more-accessible memory 242 of the integrated circuit.
[00171] With reference now to flow 3800 of FIG. 38 and to other flows described above, in some variants, several modes are presented. A first provides operation 3851 and operation 3852. A second provides operation 3855 and operation 3856. A third provides operation 3858 and operation 3859. One or more of these modes may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
[00172] Operation 3851 describes causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device (e.g. configuration module 2697 causing core 701 to draw from data queue 570). This can occur, for example, in a context in which data queue 570 resides in mobile device 160 and in which items 570 comprise data blocks, response module 1734
transmitting a signal 2052 containing a decision 1405 whether or not to cause core 702 to draw from data queue 570 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 1416 of queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086). This can occur, for example, in a context in which data queue 570 (a circular buffer, e.g.) resides in a volatile memory 262 ; in which the volume threshold 2086 signifies more than 50% of a capacity of the volatile memory 262; and in which maintaining effective processing throughput would otherwise require a continuous power expenditure through a larger fraction of event-sequencing logic 710. In another variant, moreover, operations 3851, 3852 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 751 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311 -314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 2221 of how many cores are to draw simultaneously from a single data queue 570 of a mobile device 1 0, 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 706 of the data queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086.
[00173] Operation 3852 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold (e.g. response module 1734 transmitting a signal 2052 containing a decision 1405 whether or not to cause core 702 to draw from data queue 57Θ as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 1416 of queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086). This can occur, for example, in a context in which data queue 570 (a circular buffer, e.g.) resides in a volatile memory 262; in which the volume threshold 2086 signifies more than 50% of a capacity of the volatile memory 262; and in which maintaining effective processing throughput would otherwise require a continuous power expenditure through a larger fraction of event-sequencing logic 710. In another variant, moreover, operations 3851, 3852 may be performed by a special- purpose response module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 751 having an event-sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 2221 of how many cores are to draw simultaneously from a single data queue
570 of a mobile device 160, 2760 as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume 706 of the data queue 570 crossing a volume threshold 2086.
[00174] Operation 3855 describes causing a mobile device that includes a field- programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a. configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a sorting module {e.g. configuration module 2698 transmitting a wireless signal 2053 that includes configuration data 2015 with which a configuration unit 280 in secondary device 220 implements a sorting module 594 in an FPGA (implemented in integrated circuit 365, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which configuration data 2015 comprises a Very high speed Hardware Description Language (VHDL) expression 2297; in which primary device 210 implements detection unit 2610; in which mobile device 2760 contains a circuit board 360 comprising secondary device 220; in which integrated circuit 363 comprises medium 2010; and in which integrated circuit 364 comprises ASIC 540; and in which linkage 295 spans a free space medium (air, e.g.). In some contexts, for example, such a transmission may trigger a local instance of an event-sequencing structure (a special-purpose configuration module 2698 in configuration unit 280, e.g.) configured to implement VHDL expression 2297,
[00175] Operation 3856 describes causing the sorting module in the FPG A of the mobile de vice to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the sorting modul e (e.g. input module 1681 causing sorting module 594 to process some or all of wireless signal 2054 after the configuration component of wireless signal 2053 causes sorting module 594 to be implemented in the FPGA). This can occur, for example, in a context in which the mobile device comprises supervisor unit 1630 and in which effective sorting performance would otherwise require either (1) permanent special-purpose sorting circuitry or (2) a significantly larger general-purpose processing capacity. In another variant in which a mobile device 160 or device 2760 includes FPGA 870, moreover, operation 3856 may be performed by a special-purpose input module implemented as circuitry 861 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause a sorting module 875 in FPGA 870 to process a data component 882 of wireless signal 2054 after a
configuration component 881 of another wireless signal 2053 causes the sorting module 875 to be implemented.
[00176] Operation 3858 describes causing a mobile device that includes a field- programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a. configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module (e.g. configuration module 2694 receiving a wireless signal 2055 that includes configuration data 2015 with which a configuration unit 280 implements a Fast Fourier Transform, module 591 in a field-programmable gate array comprising integrated circuit 366). This can occur, for example, in a context in which configuration data 2015 comprises a hardware description language expression 2296; in which primary device 210 comprises detection unit 2610; in which mobile device 2760 comprises secondary device 220; in which integrated circuit 363 comprises medium 2010; in which integrated circuit 364 comprises ASIC 540; and in which FFT module 591 occupies most of the capacity of the gate array. In some contexts, for example, such a transmission may trigger a local instance of an event-sequencing structure (a special- purpose configuration module 2694 in configuration unit 280, e.g. ) configured to implement hardware description language expression 2296.
[00177] Operation 3859 describes causing the FFT module in the FPGA of the mobile device to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module (e.g. input module 1682 causing FFT module 591 to process some or all of wireless signal 2056 after the configuration component of wireless signal 2055 causes FFT module 591 to be implemented in the FPGA). This can occur, for example, in a context in which the mobile device comprises supervisor unit 1630 and in which effective transform function performance would otherwise require either ( 1) a significantly larger general-purpose processing capacity or (2) an FPGA significantly larger than its resident implementation of FFT module 591. In another variant, moreover, operations 3858, 3859 may be performed by a special-purpose input module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1881 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause an FFT module 1823 in FPGA 1820 to process a data component 1842 of wireless signal
2056 after a configuration component 1841 of another wireless signal 2055 causes the FFT module 1823 to be implemented,
[00178] With reference now to flow 3900 of FIG. 39 and to other flows described above, in some variants, several modes are presented. A first provides operation 3952 and operation 3955. A second provides operation 3956 and operation 3957. A third provides operation 3958 and operation 3959. One or more of these modes may be performed in preparation for or in response to or othenvise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
[00179] Operation 3952 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from, a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1731 triggering a dual-mode core 711 to draw from data queue 580). This can occur, for example, in a context in which event-sequencing logic 710, 910 (instantiated ASIC 540 or in one or more devices 1750, 760 of network 1700, e.g.) implements the first core operating mode as a "positive" Boolean value 743 (as a nominal voltage level less than one volt at electrical node 924, e.g.) and in which dual-mode core 711 is operating in a low-voltage core operating mode 721 (manifesting Boolean value 743, e.g.).
Alternatively or additionally, such triggering may invoice special-purpose circuitry 681 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of transistors and voltage le vel s in one or more integrated circuits, e.g. ) configured to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580.
[00180] Operation 3955 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold (e.g. configuration module 2691 manifesting a decision whether or not to cause the dual-mode core 711 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580 in another core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication 1345 of a volume 706 of data queue 580 crossing volume threshold 2087). This can occur, for example, in a context in which the "other" core operating mode 722 is a higher-voltage mode (implementing a
"negative" Boolean value 743 as a nominal voltage level 314 greater than one volt at electrical node 924, e.g.) and in which maintaining effective processing throughput would
otherwise require one or more additional cores 731, 732 drawing from data queue 580, In some variants, moreover, operation 3955 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operabiy coupled with circuitry 761 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a decision 2222 whether or not to cause an activation module 709 to select and activate a. different core operating mode for one or more cores 733 partly based on Boolean value 743 and partly based on a charging sensor state 2617 of a detection unit 2610 operabiy coupled to event-sequencing logic 710.
[00181] Operation 3956 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1732 directing a dual-mode core 712 to draw from data queue 580). This can occur, for example, in a context in which event-sequencing logic 910 implements Boolean value 742 at electrical node 922 (as a voltage level, e.g.); in which ASIC 540 includes event- sequencing logic 710, 910 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 762 of network 1700, e.g. ); and in which one or more dual-mode cores 712 are operating in a higher- voltage core operating mode 722 (manifesting Boolean value 742, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such operation may comprise special-purpose circuitry 682 having an event- sequencing structure configured to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to draw from data queue 580.
[00182| Operation 3957 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular de vice in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device (e.g. configuration module 2692 signaling a decision 2224 whether or not to cause dual-mode core 712 to use a lower-voltage operating mode 721 in processing item 582 as a conditional response to temperature sensor 608 indicating a thermal state 618 hotter than a design threshold 2088). This can occur, for example, in a context in which threshold 2088 is higher than 43°C; in which temperature sensor 608 is calibrated to implement threshold 2088 by design (lacking any explicit access to thresholds 2081-2089, e.g.); in which device 1750 includes detection unit 2610 and medium 2210; in which ASIC 540 includes control logic 610; and in which such effective processing throughput would otherwise make device 1750 uncomfortable for user 1501 to hold for more than a minute. Alternatively or
additionally, in some variants, threshold 2088 may be lower than 47°C. In some variants, moreover, operation 3957 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 672 having an event-sequencing stmcture configured to signal a. decision 2224 whether or not to cause a multimodal core 635 or other configurable core 733 to change core operating modes as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608.
[00183] Operation 3958 describes causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from, a first data queue of a particular device (e.g. response module 1733 triggering a multimodal core 635 to draw from data queue 580). This can occur, for example, in a context in which ASIC 540 includes control logic 610 (instantiated in one or more devices 1760, 1770 of network 1700, e.g.) and in which control logic 610 implements a mode designation decision 2223 of "A" (signifying an error- tolerant operating mode 630 that is faster than operating mode 631 and that runs cooler than operating mode 632, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, in some variants, such triggering may invoke special-purpose circuitry 683 having an event-sequencing structure configured to cause one or more dual-mode cores 711 , 712 or other cores 731-733 to draw from data queue 580,
[00184] Operation 3959 describes signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device (e.g. configuration module 2693 acting upon a mode designation decision 2223 of "B" before or while processing item 583 from data queue 580 partly based on charging sensor 2607 indicating a sufficient charging state 2617 and partly based on another Boolean value 741). This can occur, for example, in a context in which ASIC 540 is operatively coupled with detection logic 2610; in which a mode designation decision 2223 of "B" signifies a high-latency operating mode 631 (one that runs cooler than operating mode 632 and that results in a lower error rate than that of operating mode 630, e.g.); and in which optimizing a high-throughput processing application across a family of devices (having similar architecture but different power source attributes, e.g.) would otherwise be impractical. In some contexts, for example, activation module 708 may (optionally) be configured to implement such decision 2223
by switching multimodal core 635 into its high-latency operating mode 631 immediately. Alternatively or additionally, Boolean value 741 may manifest one or more of a thermal state 618 of a temperature sensor 608 (as decision 2224, e.g.) or an indication 1345 of a volume 706 of data queue 580 crossing volume threshold 2087. In some variants, moreover, operation 3959 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2681 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a decision 2225 whether or not to cause a dual-mode core 712 to draw from data queue 580 in a higher-voltage core operating mode 722 as an automatic and conditional response to charging sensor 2607 indicating a sufficient charging state 2617.
[00185] With reference now to flow 4000 of FIG. 40 and to other flows described above, in some variants, one or more of operations 4051, 4053, 4055, 4057, 4059 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conjunction with any of the operations described above.
[001861 Operation 4051 describes detecting a series of sendee region departure events (e.g. registration module 1974 detecting occurrences of device 2910 departing from zone 2980 at position 29Θ8 and from zone 2970 at position 29Θ9, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 1910 comprises or receives data from device 2910 and in which registration module 1974 could not otherwise detect an unsuitable service availability context (driving through a thicket of noncontiguous service gaps, e.g.) would not otherwise be cost effective to implement commercially. In some contexts, for example, device 2910 can report such departure events some time later (via telephone switch 1996 or when device 2910 comes into a WLAN communication range 2866 of WLAN router 2860, e.g. ). In another variant, moreover, operation 4051 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2501 having an event-sequencing stracture configured to detect status data 2320 that includes indications 2276, 2277 of two or more such departure events. See FIG. 34.
[001871 Operation 4053 describes incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel (e.g. configuration module 2675 causing a somewhat smaller fraction 2011 of user data 2150 to pass via a wireless linkage 2767 as a
conditional response to one or more Boolean values 741-745 described herein). This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2760 includes event-sequencing logic 1210 (instantiated in one or more devices 1780, 1782 of network 1700, e.g.): in which user data 2150 comprises a series 2125 of data blocks 2121, 2122, 2123 most or all of which were obtained from user 1501 via a microphone 1217, 2817; in which at least a remainder of the user data 2150 comprises a signal 2758 passing through another channel 2780; in which channel 2770 is "wireless" by virtue of having at least one wireless linkage 2767; in which configuration module 2675 causes fraction 2011 to drop by at most about half during operation 4053; and in which such incremental decrease eases congestion in a vicinity of linkage 2767. In some contexts, for example, operation 4053 may result, from one or more indications of faster processing of signal 2758 (manifested by one or more Boolean values 742, 743 described herein, e.g.). In another variant, moreover, operation 4053 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module 2675 (in supervisor unit 1 30, e.g.) implemented as circuitry 2503 having an event- sequencing structure configured to decrease a data flow rate 2095 through linkage 151 incrementally (by an incremental adjustment to a voice sampling rate 2096 applied to a signal 2059 from microphone 1217 during a telephone call 1951 , e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which a degradation of service (dropped call, e.g.) resulting from excessi ve network resource loading would not otherwise motivate a voluntary incremental attrition of participants in interpersonal communications (video chats, e.g. ).
[00188| Operation 4055 describes signaling a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel (e.g. configuration module 2676 transmitting a Boolean decision 2226 whether or not to transmit any user data 2150 via linkage 161 as a conditional response to one or more Boolean values 741-745 described herein). This can occur, for example, in a context in which configuration module 2676 generates decision 2226 by combining Boolean values 741, 742 (with an AND gate or operation, e.g.). In some contexts, moreover, such decision 2226 may be overridden by one or more other Boolean values 743, 744 described herein being positive. In another variant, moreover, operation 4055 may be performed by a special-purpose configuration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2505 having an event-sequencing
structure configured to signal a Boolean decision 2226 whether or not to transmit any user data 2150 via queue 580.
[00189] Operation 4057 describes signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data (e.g. a special-purpose processing module 2643 signaling a decision 2227 whether or not to adjust a latency threshold 2089 for user data 2150). This can occur, for example, in a context in which user data 2150 comprises sequential video or voice data segments 2431-2433 encoded at device 1768; in which segments 2431, 2433 arrive promptly at device 1750 via wireless linkage 1771 but in which segment 2432 is significantly delayed; in which a response module 1738 applies an effective latency threshold 2089 (and an arrival time of one or more other segments, e.g.) in deciding when to treat segment 2432 as lost and to play segment 2433 (via decoding module 1151 and via a speaker 442 or display 445, e.g.); in which device 2760 event- sequencing logic 1110; and in which such playing of segment, 2433 would otherwise occur too late (due to a large latency threshold 2Θ89 that was previously necessary being maintained unnecessarily, e.g. ). In some contexts, for example, decision 2227 may result in an effective latency being reduced from 0.3 seconds to 0.1 seconds in response to an indication 2078 of a significant bit error rate decrease or to an indication 2Θ79 of a significant signal strength increase or to other such manifestations of improved channel performance received from one or more detection modules 1673, 1674 described herein. (Except as noted, such quantitative changes as described herein are "significant" if they exceed 20% of a baseline value.) In another variant, moreover, operation 4057 may be performed by a special-purpose processing module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2507 having an event-sequencing structure configured to signal a conditional decision 2227 whether or not to increase the effective latency threshold 2089 (to more than 1 second, e.g.) in response a user's activation of a speech recognition module 1123 (implemented in device 1768 or device 2760, e.g.) so that words are recognized in data segments 2431-2433 there. In some contexts, such recognized words may then be processed by a translation module (an instance of interlingual translation application module 1044 or text-to-speech translation module 1124, e.g.) before being played (via speaker 442 or display 445, e.g.).
[00190] Operation 4059 describes comparing a data block delivery failure rate against a threshold {e.g. detection module 1673 comparing a data block delivery failure rate 2091 against a threshold 2081. This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2771 includes one or more antennas 205, 1905 operably connected (via channel 2770, e.g.) with network 1990 (including device 2750, e.g.) and in which detection module 1673 would otherwise need to rely upon cruder channel metrics (signal strength or resource loading, e.g.) in deciding how to route user data 2150. Alternatively or additionally, operation 4059 may be performed by a special-purpose detection module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2509 having an event-sequencing structure configured to compare a data block delivery failure rate against a threshold as described above with reference to flow 3200.
[00191] With reference now to flow 4100 of FIG. 41 and to other flows described above, in some variants, one or more of operations 4152, 4154, 4156, 4158 may be performed in preparation for or in response to or otherwise in conj unction with any of the operations described above.
[00192] Operation 4152 describes implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator (e.g. aggregation module 1172 generating or updating a geographic model 2301 that includes a record 2327 indicating an approximate position 2341 and radius 2345 relating to a range of router 3101 and also a record 2328 indicating more complex shape-descriptive information 2313 relating to a range of router 3103). This can occur, for example, in a context in which record 2327 identifies a round region (approximating the zone 3121 served by router 3101 and having a radius 2345, e.g.); in which record 2328 identifies an oblong region (approximating the zone 3123 served by router 3103, e.g.); and in which model 2301 could not otherwise maintain an accurate geographical distribution of wireless service status in region 3155 effectively on an ongoing basis. In a context of one or more routers 3101-3103 reportedly failing to provide service (based upon a report from a device 3180 that failed to obtain service via router 3101 at position 2348, e.g.), aggregation module 1172 may update model 2301 (from version 2363 indicating service in zone 2351, e.g.) to a version 2362 showing loss of service at other positions 2349 also. Alternatively or additionally, in some contexts, operation 4152 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation
module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2502 having an event- sequencing structure (an instance of numerous transistors 351, 352 and voltage levels 311-314 in one or more integrated circuits 361, e.g.) configured to implement a model 2201 comprising an image 2251 (shown via display 445, e.g.) depicting a region 165 (served by device 160, modeled as an isotropic radiator, e.g.) and another region 155 (approximated as a semicircular map region 2255, e.g.) served by device 150
(represented as an anisotropic radiator, e.g.).
[00193] Operation 4154 describes signaling a result to a user via another device (e.g. transmission module 1183 transmitting one or more indications 1253, 254, 1341-1345, 2071-2079 as described herein remotely to a device 2760 held by user 101). This can occur, for example, in a context in which an instance of event-sequencing logic 1110 (implemented in device 776, e.g.) comprises a transmission module 183 that is remote from device 2760, In some contexts, for example, the result can comprise one or more instances (1) of clips 2090 generated by an audio capture module 1121 or by a video capture module 1121 ; (2) of coordinates 2021, 2022 from GPS module 1122; (3) of textual expressions 1432 of a word from speech recognition module 1123; (4) of decrypted data blocks from decryption module 32; (5) of decoded data blocks 2122 from decoding module 1152; (6) of maps 2330, records 2327-2329, or other
manifestation of a model 2201, 2301 from aggregation module 1174; or (7) of other such results from special-purpose event-sequencing logic (depicted in FIGS. 7-13, e.g.) or flows (depicted in FIGS. 32-41, e.g.) described herein. In some contexts, moreover, operation 4154 may be performed by a special-purpose transmission module
implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2471 remote from user 101 and having an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit a wireless signal so as to cause a manifestation of such result(s) as voltage levels (at electrical nodes 921-928, e.g.) via an instance of event-sequencing logic 2410 (and via a speaker 442 or display 445, e.g. ) that is local to user 101. This can occur, for example, in a context in which integrated circuit 440 includes event-sequencing logic 2410.
{00194] Operation 4156 describes transmitting user data via an ad hoc network (e.g. interface module 1725 or notification module 1745 routing at least some user data 2150 via one or more wireless linkages of an ad hoc network 1790). This can occur, for
example, i a context in which transmission module 1184 comprises software (resident in phase-change memory 231 or removable memory 232, e.g.) executable by CPU 212 and in which one or more devices 210, 1750, 2760 send or receive such user data 2150 (comprising one or more interpersonal communications 1961-1963, e.g.) as described herein via. wireless linkage 1771. Alternatively or additionally, operation 4156 may be performed by a special-purpose transmission module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2506 having an event-sequencing structure configured to transmit status data 2320 or other signals 2051-2059 relating to user-owned devices, e.g.) via network 1790.
[00195] Operation 4158 describes displaying via a mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost-indicative service boundary relating to a prospective
intercommunication (e.g. notification module 1741 causing a map 2330 that depicts a geographic cost transition relating to an interpersonal communication 1 61 with a user 2701 of a remote device 275Θ to be displayed before the communication begins). This can occur, for example, in a context in which user 101 views a display 445 that depicts one or more versions 2361, 2362, 2363 of a segment of map 2330 (successi vely, e.g.): in which map 2330 represents one or more such cost-indicative service boundaries as a low- cost-service region (a zone 2353 shown in green, e.g.) bordering a higher-cost-service region or free-service region (a zone 2356 shown in white, e.g.); in which such costs will be incurred by user 101 if the interpersonal communication 1961 takes place; and in which such costs would otherwise (without notification module 1741, e.g.) be incurred without adequate warning. In some contexts, for example, one or more such versions 2361 depict a cost transition relating to costs that will be incurred by the user 2701 of the remote device 2750 (a zone 2351 shown in orange bordered by another cost-indicative service boundary, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such zone 2351 depicted in orange may become available (in a newer version 2363 of segment 2337, e.g.) as a response to user 2701 placing a call to device 2760 (while device 2760 is ringing, e.g.). Alternatively or additionally, such zone 2351 depicted in orange may become available (to user 101, activated by saying "local roaming map" or by pushing a button, e.g.) as a response to user 101 entering user data 2150 (via. a keypad of device 2760, e.g.) that identifies device 2750 (phone number 2285, e.g.). In another variant, moreover, operation 4158 may be
performed by a. special-purpose notification module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 2508 having an event-sequencing structure configured to maintain a regional map 2330 (on server 1396, e.g.) that features one or more cost- indicative service boundaries 2961, 2971 relating to prospective intercommunications via device 2910. One or more versions of regional map 2330 may be updated, in some variants, in response to a positional or other status indication (signifying coordinates 2021, 2022 or operability status, e.g.) relating one or more service facilitation devices. In some contexts, for example, such devices (instantiated in one or more devices 1772, 1782 of network 1700, e.g.) may include a tower 3085 or vehicle 1510 or mounted device 1530, [00196] Referring again to the flow variants of FIGS. 32-41 described above and in particular to flow 3200, operation 28 may be performed by one or more special-purpose initiation modules implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1031 having an event-sequencing structure configured to establish a first wireless communication channel via linkage 1771 (e.g. including intermediate devices 1770, 1772) and from device 1750 and a second wireless communication channel from device 1750 and via device 1776. This can occur, for example in a context in which such channels both extend to a remote device 1782. Also in such variants, operation 32 may be performed by a special-purpose allocation module implemented as circuitry 1141 having an event- sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 921 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to implement an adjusted target percentage 2293 of user data 2150 being transmitted via linkage 1771 responsive to data block delivery failures of the second wireless communication channel becoming to frequent.
[00197] Referring again to the flow variants of FIGS. 32-41 described above and in particular to flow 3300, operation 24 may be performed by a special-purpose registration module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1481 having an event- sequencing stracture configured to obtain at primary device 2760 an internet protocol address or other identifier of device 2760. Also in such variants, operation 30 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as circuitry 1221 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 925 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to cause a
primary device 2760 to indicate whether or not device 2760 is within zone 2960. This can occur, for example, in a. context in which the "third" device comprises a. vehicle or mounted device 1530 providing wireless service 1335; in which the WLAN
communication range comprises region 165 or zone 2960; in which primary device 2760 is not currently engaged in a bidirectional interpersonal communication via device 2760; and in which primary device 2760 includes a light-emitting diode or other suitable display 445 configured to display the Boolean indication. Alternatively or additionally, in some variants, the third device may comprise a moving vehicle 1510 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 776 of network 1700, e.g. ) or parked vehicle (comprising device 160, e.g.) providing Wi-Fi sendee.
[00198] Referring again to the flow variants of FIGS. 32-41 described above and in particular to flow 3400, operation 27 may be performed by a special-purpose detection module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1483 having an event- sequencing structure configured to detect an availability to participate in one or more modes of telephonic dialog 1953 as a conditionally response to an indirect Boolean indication 2274 whether or not a device 2910 (instantiated in one or more devices 1750, 1780 of network 1700, e.g.) crossed boundaries too rapidl (as a determination of whether an average or other interval 1423 between events exceeded a threshold, said determination being an inverse of Boolean indication 2274, e.g.) within time interval 1421. Also in such variants, operation 33 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as circuitry 1482 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 926 at decision-indicative voltage levels operably coupled to detection the module, e.g.) configured to signal the availability to participate in telephonic dialog 1953 in response to a successful communication via router 3101. This can occur, for example, in a context in which device 2910 is at position 2349 and in which router 3101 is online (providing wireless service 1331 in zone 2351, e.g.).
[00199] Referring again to the flow variants of FIGS. 32-41 described above and in particular to flow 3500, operation 26 may be performed by a special-purpose notification module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 931 having an event- sequencing structure configured to obtain via an antenna 1905 (and via a. wireless linkage
995 from configuration unit 980, e.g.) configuration data (a VHDL expression 2297 or password 2036, e.g.) establishing a security protocol (manifested as an event-sequencing structure in an FPGA 870, 1540, 1820 or as a protocol implementation code 1088 executable by CPU 212, e.g.). This can occur, for example, in a context in which event- sequencing logic 910 and media 2010, 2210 reside in device 1750 and in which a scripting language is used to generate VHDL expression 2297 or in which a password generation module 986 (resident in a device 1750,1 758 of network 1700, e.g. ) is used to generate password 2036. Also in such variants, operation 29 may be performed by a special-purpose interface module implemented as circuitry 1201 having an event- sequencing structure configured to receive a wireless signal that includes password 2036. This can occur, for example, in a context, in which device 1750 includes event- sequencing logic 1210 and receives the wireless signal from device 2760 (as the "second" device, e.g.). Also in such variants, operation 31 may be performed by a special-purpose registration module implemented as circuitry 1021 having an event-sequencing structure coniigured to signal a decision 2228 whether or not to provide a network access service 2284 responsive to whether or not access request data in the wireless signal (password 2036, e.g.) satisfies the security protocol (a watermark or checksum, e.g.). Also in such variants, operation 35 may be performed by a special-purpose allocation module implemented as circuitry 1022 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 927 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) coniigured to signal a decision whether or not to provide another network access service 2282, 2283 responsive to whether or not access request data from another mobile device 2870 satisfies another security protocol (e.g. controlling access to one or more other services 2282, 2283). This can occur, for example, in a context in which allocation module 1622 also implements circuitry 1371 having an event-sequencing structure configured to implement a firewall separating two or more network access services 2282- 2284 provided via a single device 1750.
[00200] Referring again to the flow variants of FIGS. 32-41 described above and in particular to flow 3600, operation 25 may be performed by a special-purpose aggregation module implemented as or operably coupled with circuitry 1372 having an event- sequencing structure configured to obtain an indication 1344 of one or more wireless
communication services 1331-1335 having been provided within zone 2970. Also in such variants, operation 34 may be performed by a special-purpose response module implemented as circuitry 941 having an event-sequencing structure (an arrangement of numerous transistors and electrical nodes 928 at decision-indicative voltage levels, e.g.) configured to signal a decision 1403 whether or not to indicate the wireless
communication service(s) provided within zone 2970 by a device 3160 as a response to an indication 2077 from another device 2910 of the wireless communication service(s) being operative within zone 2970,
[00201] The foregoing detailed description has set forth various embodiments of the devices and/or processes via the use of block diagrams, fl owcharts, and/or examples. Insofar as such block diagrams, flowcharts, and/or examples contain one or more functions and/or operations, it will be understood by those within the art that each function and/or operation within such block diagrams, flowcharts, or examples can be implemented, individually and/or collectively, by a wide range of hardware, software, firmware, or virtually any combination thereof. In one embodiment, several portions of the subject matter described herein may be implemented via Application Specific Integrated Circuits (ASICs), Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs), digital signal processors (DSPs), or other integrated formats. However, those skilled in the art will recognize that some aspects of the embodiments disclosed herein, in whole or in part, can be equivalently implemented in integrated circuits, as one or more computer programs running on one or more computers (e.g., as one or more programs running on one or more computer systems), as one or more programs running on one or more processors (e.g., as one or more programs running on one or more microprocessors), as firmware, or as virtually any combination thereof, and that designing the circuitry and/or writing the code for the software and or firmware would be well within the skill of one of skill in the art in light of this disclosure. In addition, those skilled in the art will appreciate that the mechanisms of the subject matter described herein are capable of being distributed as a program product in a variety of forms, and that an illustrative embodiment of the subject matter described herein applies regardless of the particular type of signal bearing medium used to actually carry out the distribution. Examples of a. signal bearing medium include, but are not limited to, the following: a recordable type medium such as a floppy disk, a
hard disk drive, a Compact Disc (CD), a Digital Video Disk (DVD), a digital tape, a computer memory, etc.; and a. transmission type medium such as a. digital and/or an analog communication medium (e.g., a fiber optic cable, a waveguide, a wired communications link, a wireless communication link (e.g., transmitter, receiver, transmission logic, reception logic, etc.), etc.).
[00202] While particular aspects of the present subject, matter described herein have been shown and described, it, will be apparent to those skilled in the art that, based upon the teachings herein, changes and modifications may be made without departing from the subject matter described herein and its broader aspects and, therefore, the appended claims are to encompass within their scope all such changes and modifications as are within the true spirit and scope of the subject, matter described herein. It will be understood by those within the art, that, in general, terms used herein, and especially in the appended claims (e.g., bodies of the appended claims) are generally intended as "open" terms (e.g., the term "including" should be interpreted as "including but not limited to," the term "having" should be interpreted as "having at least," the term
"includes" should be interpreted as "includes but is not limited to," etc).
[00203] It will be further understood by those within the art that if a specific number of an introduced claim recitation is intended, such an intent will be explicitly recited in the claim, and in the absence of such recitation no such intent is present. For example, as an aid to understanding, the following appended claims may contain usage of the introductory phrases "at least one" and "one or more" to introduce claim recitations. However, the use of such phrases should not be construed to imply that the introduction of a claim recitation by the indefinite articles "a" or "an" limits any particular claim containing such introduced claim recitation to claims containing only one such recitation, even when the same claim includes the introductory phrases "one or more" or "at least one" and indefinite articles such as "a" or "an" (e.g., "a" and/or "an" should typically be interpreted to mean "at least one" or "one or more"); the same holds true for the use of definite articles used to introduce claim recitations. In addition, even if a specific number of an introduced claim recitation is explicitly recited, those skilled in the art will recognize that such recitation should typically be interpreted to mean at least the recited
number (e.g., the bare recitation of "two recitations," without other modifiers, typically means at least two recitations, or two or more recitations).
[00204] Furthermore, in those instances where a convention analogous to "at least one of A, B, and C, etc." is used, in general such a construction is intended in the sense one having skill in the art would understand the convention (e.g., " a system having at least one of A, B, and C" would include but, not be limited to systems that have A alone, B alone, C alone, A. and B together, A and C together, B and C together, and/or A, B, and C together, etc.). In those instances where a convention analogous to "at least one of A, B, or C, etc." is used, in general such a construction is intended in the sense one having skill in the art would understand the convention (e.g., " a system having at least one of A, B, or C" would include but not be limited to systems that have A alone, B alone, C alone, A and B together, A and C together, B and C together, and/or A, B, and C together, etc.). It will be further understood by those within the art that typically a disjunctive word and/or phrase presenting two or more alternative terms, whether in the description, claims, or drawings, should be understood to contemplate the possibilities of including one of the terms, either of the terms, or both terms unless context dictates otherwise. For example, the phrase "A or B" will be typically understood to include the possibilities of "A" or "B" or "A and B."
[00205] This application may make reference to one or more trademarks, e.g., a word, letter, symbol, or device adopted by one manufacturer or merchant and used to identify and/or distinguish his or her product from those of others. Trademark names used herein are set forth in such language that makes clear their identity, that distinguishes them from common descriptive nouns, that have fixed and definite meanings, or, in many if not all cases, are accompanied by other specific identification using terms not covered by trademark. In addition, trademark names used herein have meanings that are well- known and defined in the literature, or do not refer to products or compounds for which knowledge of one or more trade secrets is required in order to divine their meaning. Ail trademarks referenced in this application are the property of their respective owners, and the appearance of one or more trademarks in this application does not diminish or otherwise adversely affect the validity of the one or more trademarks. All trademarks, registered or unregistered, that appear in this application are assumed to include a proper
trademark symbol, e.g., the circle R or bracketed capitalization (e.g., [trademark name]), even when such trademark symbol does not explicitly appear next to the trademark. To the extent a trademark is used in a descriptive manner to refer to a product or process, that trademark should be interpreted to represent the corresponding product or process as of the date of the filing of this patent application.
[00206] With respect to the numbered clauses and claims expressed below, those skilled in the art will appreciate that recited operations therein may generally be performed in any order. Also, although various operational flows are presented in a sequence(s), it should be understood that the various operations may be performed in other orders than those which are illustrated, or may be performed concurrently. Examples of such alternate orderings may include overlapping, interleaved, interrupted, reordered, incremental, preparatory, supplemental, simultaneous, reverse, or other variant orderings, unless context dictates otherwise. Furthermore, terms like "responsive to," "related to," or other past-tense adjectives are generally not intended to exclude such variants, unless context dictates otherwise. Also in the numbered clauses below, specific combinations of aspects and embodiments are articulated in a shorthand form such that (1 ) according to respective embodiments, for each instance in which a "component" or other such identifiers appear to be introduced (with "a" or "an," e.g.) more than once in a given chain of clauses, such designations may either identify the same entity or distinct entities; and (2) what might be called "dependent" clauses below may or may not incorporate, in respective embodiments, the features of "independent" clauses to which they refer or other features described above.
[00207| Those skilled in the art will appreciate that the foregoing specific exemplary processes and/or devices and/or technologies are representative of more general processes and/or devices and'Or technologies taught elsewhere herein, such as in the claims filed herewith and/or elsewhere in the present application.
CLAUSES
5. (Independent) A communication management system comprising:
one or more articl es of manufacture including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service,
2. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device comprising one or more metamaterial elements configured to transmit the wireless signal containing the access request data.
3. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device comprising an antenna that transmits the configuration data establishing the first security protocol, the configuration data comprising a password.
4. The communication management system of any of the above SY STEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device comprising a smartphone or comprising a computer.
5. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTE
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device comprising an integrated circuit chip or comprising a motor vehicle.
6. The communication management system of any of the above SY STEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device configured to signal a decision whether or not to indicate a wireless communication service provided within a region by a. fourth device as a response to an
indication from a fifth device of the wireless communication service being operative within the region, the wireless communication service being the first network access service,
7. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device configured to display at least some of a map that includes a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective interpersonal communication between the second device and a fifth device.
8. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the third device including a field-programmable gate array configured to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module,
9. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device including a control module configured as the firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
10. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
one or more electrical nodes, the configuration data establishing the first security protocol being manifested as an arrangement of one or more voltage levels on the one or more electrical nodes.
11. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
one or more electrical nodes, the decision whether or not to provide the second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the second security protocol being manifested as an arrangement of one or more voltage levels on the one or more electrical nodes.
12. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device comprising a subsystem of a mesh network.
13. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device including a microphone configured to generate user data from a vocalization.
14. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device including a speaker configured to generate an audible indication of whether or not a fourth device is available to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication via the third device at least partly based on an indication of the fourth device being within a wireless communication range of a fifth device.
15. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the one or more articles of manufacture being configured not to transmit data indicating a ground speed of any of the one or more articl es of manufacture.
16. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the one or more articles of manufacture being configured not to transmit data indicating a geographic position of any of the one or more articles of manufacture.
1 7. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device including the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the second security protocol.
18. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the first device including the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol.
19. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device, the handheld device being the second device.
20. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device, the portable device being the second device.
21. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a. mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a
control component of the wireless signal, the mobile device being the second device.
22. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or thro ugh a. second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion, the particular device being the second device.
23. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device, the mobile device being the third device; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold.
24. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the
third device respo sive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA. to implement a sorting module, the mobile device being the third device; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the sorting module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPG A to implement the sorting module.
25. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to recei ve a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPG A to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the FFT module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module, the mobile device being the third device.
26. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the
third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device: and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold,
27. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device.
28. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor- based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device: and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a. decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device,
29. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for detecting a series of service region departure events.
30. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
31. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a. decision whether or not to transmit any user data via. a first communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
32. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data passing via a first communication channel in response to one or more channel performance metrics relating to the first communication channel.
33. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for comparing a data block delivery failure rate relating to a first communication channel against a failure rate threshold relating to the first communication channel.
34. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the second device to display an indication of the specific positional model.
35. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a result to a user via a fourth device, the result being an indication of whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol.
36. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for transmitting user data via an ad hoc network that includes the second device.
37. The communication management system of any of the above SYSTEM
CLAUSES, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for displaying via a. mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost-
indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the mobile device being the second device.
38. (Independent) A communication management method comprising:
obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first, network access sen'ice via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service a d the second network access service.
39. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device, the handheld device being the second device.
40. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device, the portable device being the second device.
41. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a data component of a wireless signal to be processed by a special- purpose module in a mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to a control component of the wireless signal, the m obile device being the second device,
42. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particular device or through a second memory of the particular device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion, the particular device being the second device.
43. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device, the mobile device being the third device; and
signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold.
44. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol includi g
causing a mobile device that includes a. field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA. to implement a sorting module, the mobile device being the third device; and
causing the sorting module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first, wireless signal causes the FPG A to implement the sorting module.
45. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to receive a configuration component of a first wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) module; and
causing the FFT module to process a data component of a second wireless signal after the configuration component of the first wirel ess signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module, the mobile device being the third device.
46. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an
automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold,
47. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first, data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device.
48. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device.
49. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
detecting a series of service region departure events.
50. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
51. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
signaling a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
52. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data passing via a first communication channel in response to one or more channel performance metrics relating to the first communication channel.
53. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
comparing a data block delivery failure rate relating to a first communication channel against a failure rate threshold relating to the first communication channel.
54. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator; and
causing the second device to display an indication of the specific positional model.
55. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
signaling a result to a user via a fourth device, the result being an indication of whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol.
56. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
transmitting user data via an ad hoc network that includes the second device.
57. The communication management method of any of the above METHOD
CLAUSES further comprising:
the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
displaying via a mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the mobile device being the second device.
58. (Independent) A communication management method comprising:
establishing both a wireless communication channel via a first device and from a second device and a wireless communication channel from the second device and via a third device; and
signaling a decision of how much user data to transmit via. the wireless communication channel from the second device and via the third device responsive to an indication that a data block delivery failure rate of the wireless communication channel via the first device and from the second device exceeds a failure rate threshold,
59. The communication management, method of CLAUSE 58 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
60. (Independent) A communication management method comprising:
obtaining at a first device an identifier of a second device; and
causing the first device to display a Boolean indication whether or not the second device is within a wireless local area network communication range of a third device without a bidirectional interpersonal communication existing between the first device and the second device.
61. The communication management method of CLAUSE 60 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
62. (Independent) A communication management method comprising:
obtaining a Boolean indication of whether or not a first de vice exceeded a wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within a recent time interval, the recent time interval being less than an hour; and
signaling an availability to participate in a bidirectional interpersonal communication conditionally, partly based on the Boolean indication whether or not the first device exceeded the wireless service boundary crossing rate threshold within the recent time interval and partly based on a Boolean indication of the first device being within a wireless communication range of a second device.
63. The communication management method of CLAU SE 62 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
64. (Independent) A communication management method comprising:
obtaining an indication of a. first wireless communication service having been provided within a first se dee region by a first device at an earlier time; and
signaling a decision whether or not to indicate the first wireless communication service being operative within the first service region as an automatic and conditional response to an indication from a second device of the first wireless communication service having been operative within the first service region or not at a later time,
65. The communication management method of CLAUSE 64 further comprising: performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES that depend from METHOD CLAUSE 38.
66. (Independent) A system comprising:
means for performing the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES.
67. (Independent) An article of manufacture comprising:
one or more physical media configured to bear a device-detectable implementation of a method including at least
obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol; obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
68. The article of manufacture of CLAUSE 67 in which a portion of the one or more physical media comprises:
one or more signal-bearing media configured to transmit a binary sequence manifesting one or more device-executable instructions configured to perform the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES.
69. (Independent) An article of manufacture comprising:
one or more physical media bearing a device-detectable output manifesting an occurrence of
obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol: obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via. a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service,
70. The article of manufacture of CLAUSE 69 in which a portion of the one or more physical media comprises:
one or more signal-bearing media bearing at least one binary sequence from an event- sequencing structure configured to perform the operation(s) of any one or more of the above METHOD CLAUSES.
All of the patents and other publications referred to above are incorporated herein by reference generally including those identified in relation to particular new applications of existing techniques to the extent not inconsistent herewith (in each respective latest edition, where applicable). While various system, method, article of manufacture, or other embodiments or aspects have been disclosed above, also, other combinations of embodiments or aspects will be apparent to those skilled in the art in view of the above disclosure. The various embodiments and aspects disclosed above are for purposes of illustration and are not intended to be limiting, with the true scope and spirit being indicated in the final claim set that follows.
Claims
What is claimed is:
1. A communication management system comprising:
one or more articles of manufacture including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a first, device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol ; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service.
2. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the one or more articles of manufacture being an integrated circuit (IC) chip having a first portion and a second portion and a third portion, the first portion of the IC chip being the event-sequencing stracture configured for obtaining via the first device configuration data establishing the first security protocol, the second portion of the IC chip being the event-sequencing stracture configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol.
3. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device comprising one or more metamaterial elements configured to transmit the wireless signal containing the access request data.
4. The coniinunication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device comprising an antenna that transmits the co figuration data establishi g the first security protocol, the configuration data comprising a password,
5. The coniinunication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device comprising a smartphone or comprising a computer,
6. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising;
the third device comprising an integrated circuit chip or comprising a motor vehicle.
7. The communication management, system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
one or more electrical nodes, the configuration data establishing the first, security protocol being manifested as an arrangement of one or more voltage levels on the one or more electrical nodes.
8. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the second device including a microphone configured to generate user data from a vocalization.
9. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the third device including the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the second security protocol.
10. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the first device including the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol.
1 1. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a first, core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device, the mobile device being the third device; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold.
52. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold.
13. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device.
14. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device.
15. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for detecting a series of service region departure events,
16. The communication management, system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
17. The communication management system of claim 5 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a first communication channel comprising the second device and the third device.
18. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data passing via a first communication channel in response to one or more channel performance metrics relating to the first, communication channel,
19. The communication management, system of claim 1, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for comparing a data block delivery failure rate relating to a first communication channel against a failure rate threshold relating to the first communication channel.
20. The communication management system of claim 1, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the second device to display an indication of the specific positional model.
21. The communication management system of claim 1, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a result to a user via a fourth device, the result being an indication of whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol.
22. The communication management system of claim 1, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for transmitting user data via an ad hoc network that includes the second device.
23. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for displaying via a mobile device at least some of a map that depicts a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the mobile device being the second device.
24. A communication management system comprising:
one or more articles of manufacture including
means for obtaining via a. first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol;
means for obtaining via a. second device a. wireless signal containing access request data;
means for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol and for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service,
25. The communication management system of claim 24, the one or more articles of manufacture comprising:
the means for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
means for causing a first core to draw from a first data queue of a mobile device and for signaling a decision whether or not to cause a second core to draw from the first data queue of the mobile device as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a backlog threshold, the mobile device being the third device.
26. A communication management method comprising:
obtaining via a first device configuration data establishing a first security protocol: obtaining via a second device a wireless signal containing access request data;
signaling a decision whether or not to provide a first network access service via a third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol; and
invoking transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to provide a second network access service via the
third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies a second security protocol, the third device implementing a firewall between the first network access service and the second network access service,
27, The communication management method of claim 26 further comprising: the signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol including
causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; and signaling a decision whether or not, to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data queue crossing a volume threshold.
28, The communication management system of claim 5 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for comparing a data block delivery failure rate relating to a first communication channel against a failure rate threshold relating to the first communication channel;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; transistor- based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to an indication of a data volume of the first data, queue crossing a volume threshold: and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to transmit any user data via a second communication channel, the second communication channel passing through the third device.
29. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for displaying via a mobile device at, least some of a map that depicts a cost- indicative sendee boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the mobile device being the second device, the wireless signal being a first wireless signal;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to adjust a latency threshold for user data passing via a first communication channel in response to one or more channel performance metrics relating to the first communication channel, the user data being a component of a second wireless signal;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular device in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the particular device; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a third wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a handheld device as an automatic and conditional
response to a thermal state of a temperature sensor in the handheld device, the handheld device being the second device,
30. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not, to provide the first network access service via the third device responsive to whether or not, the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for detecting a series of service region departure events;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a. configurable core in a first core operating mode to draw from a first data queue of a particular device, the particular device being the third device; transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a decision whether or not to cause the configurable core to draw from the first data queue of the particular de vice in a second core operating mode as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the particular device;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for incrementally decreasing a dataflow through a wireless communication channel passing through the third device; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing first content of a wireless signal to pass either through a first memory of a particul ar device or through a second memory of the particul ar device selected as an automatic and conditional response to whether or not second content of the wireless signal satisfies a first criterion, the particular device being the second device.
31. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data, in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for transmitting user data via an ad hoc network that includes the second device, the wireless signal being a first wireless signal, a second wireless signal including the user data;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a data component of a third wireless signal to be processed by a special-purpose module in a portable device as an automatic and conditional response to a charging state of a battery in the portable device, the portable device being the second device;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPGA) to recei ve a configuration component of a fourth wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a sorting module, the mobile device being the third device;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the sorting module to process a data component of a fifth wireless signal after the configuration component of the fourth wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the sorting module; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for displaying via the second device at least some of a map that depicts a cost- indicative service boundary relating to a prospective intercommunication, the second device being another mobile device.
32. The communication management system of claim 1 , the one or more articles of manufacture further comprising:
the transistor-based circuitry having the event-sequencing structure configured for signaling the decision whether or not to provide the first network access service via. the third device responsive to whether or not the access request data in the wireless signal satisfies the first, security protocol including
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for signaling a result to a user via a fourth device, the result being an indication of whether or not the access request data satisfies the first security protocol, the wireless signal being a first wireless signal;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing a mobile device that includes a field-programmable gate array (FPG A) to receive a configuration component of a second wireless signal, the configuration component causing the FPGA to implement a Fast Fourier
Transform (FFT) module;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the FFT module to process a data component of a third wireless signal after the configuration component of the second wireless signal causes the FPGA to implement the FFT module, the mobile device being the third device;
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for implementing a specific positional model to represent both an isotropic radiator and an anisotropic radiator; and
transistor-based circuitry having an event-sequencing structure configured for causing the second device to display an indication of the specific positional model.
Priority Applications (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
CN201380074172.7A CN105122734A (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
EP13867549.1A EP2939370A4 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
Applications Claiming Priority (18)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US13/731,930 US9832628B2 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2012-12-31 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
US13/731,982 US9876762B2 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2012-12-31 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
US13/731,952 | 2012-12-31 | ||
US13/731,952 US8965288B2 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2012-12-31 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
US13/731,907 US9781664B2 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2012-12-31 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
US13/732,004 US9451394B2 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2012-12-31 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
US13/731,907 | 2012-12-31 | ||
US13/732,004 | 2012-12-31 | ||
US13/731,982 | 2012-12-31 | ||
US13/731,930 | 2012-12-31 | ||
US13/908,738 US9635605B2 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2013-06-03 | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications |
US13/908,713 US9713013B2 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2013-06-03 | Protocols for providing wireless communications connectivity maps |
US13/908,687 | 2013-06-03 | ||
US13/908,738 | 2013-06-03 | ||
US13/908,687 US20140273935A1 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2013-06-03 | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications |
US13/908,658 US9980114B2 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2013-06-03 | Systems and methods for communication management |
US13/908,658 | 2013-06-03 | ||
US13/908,713 | 2013-06-03 |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
WO2014106199A1 true WO2014106199A1 (en) | 2014-07-03 |
Family
ID=51022115
Family Applications (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2013/078343 WO2014106199A1 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
PCT/US2013/078330 WO2014106191A1 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
PCT/US2013/078349 WO2014106201A1 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2013/078330 WO2014106191A1 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
PCT/US2013/078349 WO2014106201A1 (en) | 2012-12-31 | 2013-12-30 | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols |
Country Status (3)
Country | Link |
---|---|
EP (2) | EP2939370A4 (en) |
CN (2) | CN105103528A (en) |
WO (3) | WO2014106199A1 (en) |
Cited By (1)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN105610457A (en) * | 2015-12-19 | 2016-05-25 | 西安拓奇电子科技有限公司 | Outdoor communication system |
Families Citing this family (3)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
RU184072U1 (en) * | 2018-04-04 | 2018-10-15 | Дмитрий Андреевич Попов | HIGH-EFFICIENT COMPUTING DEVICE FOR PROCESSING Cryptocurrency Data |
CN114979232B (en) * | 2022-05-23 | 2023-05-26 | 浙江传媒学院 | Construction method of mobile web augmented reality decentralizing collaborative rendering computing network |
CN115118676B (en) * | 2022-08-29 | 2022-11-11 | 科来网络技术股份有限公司 | Heterogeneous system data communication interaction method, system and terminal based on central platform |
Citations (7)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6380910B1 (en) * | 2001-01-10 | 2002-04-30 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Wireless communications device having a compact antenna cluster |
US20100201516A1 (en) * | 1999-10-06 | 2010-08-12 | Gelvin David C | Apparatus for Compact Internetworked Wireless Integrated Network Sensors (WINS) |
US8060017B2 (en) * | 2008-04-04 | 2011-11-15 | Powerwave Cognition, Inc. | Methods and systems for a mobile, broadband, routable internet |
US20110298669A1 (en) * | 2010-06-08 | 2011-12-08 | Research In Motion Limited | Low frequency dual-antenna diversity system |
US8145219B2 (en) * | 2004-07-28 | 2012-03-27 | Broadcom Corporation | Handoff of a multimedia call session using background network scanning |
US8199654B2 (en) * | 2005-06-21 | 2012-06-12 | Alcatel Lucent | Method and apparatus for providing end-to-end high quality services based on performance characterizations of network conditions |
US20120148043A1 (en) * | 2010-12-10 | 2012-06-14 | At&T Intellectual Property 1 Lp | Network Access Via Telephony Services |
Family Cites Families (21)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6862622B2 (en) * | 1998-07-10 | 2005-03-01 | Van Drebbel Mariner Llc | Transmission control protocol/internet protocol (TCP/IP) packet-centric wireless point to multi-point (PTMP) transmission system architecture |
JP2933615B1 (en) * | 1998-07-15 | 1999-08-16 | 静岡日本電気株式会社 | Channel switching decision device in digital cordless |
EP1544787A1 (en) * | 2003-12-19 | 2005-06-22 | Axalto SA | Contactless card including an antenna switch |
US8165109B2 (en) * | 2004-11-10 | 2012-04-24 | Cisco Technology, Inc. | Method for managing the quality of encrypted voice over IP to teleagents |
US8880047B2 (en) * | 2005-08-03 | 2014-11-04 | Jeffrey C. Konicek | Realtime, location-based cell phone enhancements, uses, and applications |
CN100388664C (en) * | 2005-12-16 | 2008-05-14 | 西安电子科技大学 | Access method for realizing WLAN multi mode safety identification |
CN101094225B (en) * | 2006-11-24 | 2011-05-11 | 中兴通讯股份有限公司 | Network, system and method of differentiated security service |
US8775450B2 (en) * | 2007-04-19 | 2014-07-08 | Sap Ag | Systems and methods for information exchange using object warehousing |
US8260366B2 (en) * | 2007-09-28 | 2012-09-04 | At&T Intellectual Property I, Lp | Automatic setting of an alert mode on a wireless device |
US8155138B2 (en) * | 2008-08-19 | 2012-04-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Training sequences for very high throughput wireless communication |
CN101860786A (en) * | 2009-04-09 | 2010-10-13 | 北京易安特信息科技有限公司 | Method and system for managing domain-based mobile node |
ATE512556T1 (en) * | 2009-04-20 | 2011-06-15 | Alcatel Lucent | TRANSFER PROCEDURE |
US8488724B2 (en) * | 2009-05-14 | 2013-07-16 | Silvus Technologies, Inc. | Wideband interference mitigation for devices with multiple receivers |
US20110082621A1 (en) * | 2009-10-02 | 2011-04-07 | Eric Berkobin | Method and system for predicting battery life based on vehicle battery, usage, and environmental data |
US8369841B2 (en) * | 2010-02-16 | 2013-02-05 | Thaddeus John Kobylarz | Invoke facility service and its applications to compound wireless mobile communication services |
US20110227925A1 (en) * | 2010-03-16 | 2011-09-22 | Imb Corporation | Displaying a visualization of event instances and common event sequences |
WO2011149558A2 (en) * | 2010-05-28 | 2011-12-01 | Abelow Daniel H | Reality alternate |
US20120072990A1 (en) * | 2010-09-22 | 2012-03-22 | The Boeing Company | Cost function for data transmission |
CN101959203B (en) * | 2010-10-11 | 2012-10-24 | 清华大学 | Wireless communication method of LTE (Long Term Evolution) network comprising macro cell base station and home base station |
JP5547106B2 (en) * | 2011-02-01 | 2014-07-09 | クラリオン株式会社 | Route arithmetic unit |
WO2012150880A1 (en) * | 2011-05-02 | 2012-11-08 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Method in a radio network node for controlling handover decision of a user equipment |
-
2013
- 2013-12-30 EP EP13867549.1A patent/EP2939370A4/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2013-12-30 WO PCT/US2013/078343 patent/WO2014106199A1/en active Application Filing
- 2013-12-30 WO PCT/US2013/078330 patent/WO2014106191A1/en active Application Filing
- 2013-12-30 EP EP13866738.1A patent/EP2939409A4/en not_active Withdrawn
- 2013-12-30 WO PCT/US2013/078349 patent/WO2014106201A1/en active Application Filing
- 2013-12-30 CN CN201380074173.1A patent/CN105103528A/en active Pending
- 2013-12-30 CN CN201380074172.7A patent/CN105122734A/en active Pending
Patent Citations (7)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20100201516A1 (en) * | 1999-10-06 | 2010-08-12 | Gelvin David C | Apparatus for Compact Internetworked Wireless Integrated Network Sensors (WINS) |
US6380910B1 (en) * | 2001-01-10 | 2002-04-30 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Wireless communications device having a compact antenna cluster |
US8145219B2 (en) * | 2004-07-28 | 2012-03-27 | Broadcom Corporation | Handoff of a multimedia call session using background network scanning |
US8199654B2 (en) * | 2005-06-21 | 2012-06-12 | Alcatel Lucent | Method and apparatus for providing end-to-end high quality services based on performance characterizations of network conditions |
US8060017B2 (en) * | 2008-04-04 | 2011-11-15 | Powerwave Cognition, Inc. | Methods and systems for a mobile, broadband, routable internet |
US20110298669A1 (en) * | 2010-06-08 | 2011-12-08 | Research In Motion Limited | Low frequency dual-antenna diversity system |
US20120148043A1 (en) * | 2010-12-10 | 2012-06-14 | At&T Intellectual Property 1 Lp | Network Access Via Telephony Services |
Non-Patent Citations (1)
Title |
---|
See also references of EP2939370A4 * |
Cited By (1)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN105610457A (en) * | 2015-12-19 | 2016-05-25 | 西安拓奇电子科技有限公司 | Outdoor communication system |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
EP2939409A4 (en) | 2016-05-18 |
CN105122734A (en) | 2015-12-02 |
CN105103528A (en) | 2015-11-25 |
WO2014106201A1 (en) | 2014-07-03 |
EP2939370A1 (en) | 2015-11-04 |
EP2939370A4 (en) | 2016-12-21 |
WO2014106191A1 (en) | 2014-07-03 |
EP2939409A1 (en) | 2015-11-04 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US8965288B2 (en) | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols | |
US9713013B2 (en) | Protocols for providing wireless communications connectivity maps | |
US20180145947A1 (en) | Cost-Effective Mobile Connectivity Protocols | |
US9635605B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications | |
US9706382B2 (en) | Protocols for allocating communication services cost in wireless communications | |
US9813887B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications responsive to charge authorization statuses | |
US9596584B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications by conditionally authorizing a charge to an account of a third party | |
US9781554B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating third party authorization for a rooted communication device in wireless communications | |
US9826439B2 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems operable in network equipment | |
US9706060B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications | |
US20140273924A1 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications | |
US9832628B2 (en) | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols | |
US9843917B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating charge-authorized connectivity in wireless communications | |
US9866706B2 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications | |
US9774728B2 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems in a context of plural communication records | |
US20150095477A1 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems featuring party identifier inclusions that are conditional | |
WO2014106199A1 (en) | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols | |
US9805208B2 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems with recipient-dependent inclusion of a data selection | |
US20150094047A1 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems featuring routing tag derivation | |
US20140273935A1 (en) | Protocols for facilitating broader access in wireless communications | |
US9451394B2 (en) | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols | |
US9781664B2 (en) | Cost-effective mobile connectivity protocols | |
US9980114B2 (en) | Systems and methods for communication management | |
US20150095421A1 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems featuring a recipient-selective default address determination | |
US9740875B2 (en) | Mobile device sharing facilitation methods and systems featuring exclusive data presentation |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
121 | Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application |
Ref document number: 13867549 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |
|
NENP | Non-entry into the national phase |
Ref country code: DE |
|
WWE | Wipo information: entry into national phase |
Ref document number: 2013867549 Country of ref document: EP |